blob: ad507888e566695f7b2e89a5af205ee4aa64e29b [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau73b943b2020-05-22 16:19:04 +02007 2020/05/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200607 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100608 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200609 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100610 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200611 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200612 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200613 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200614 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200616 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100617 - presetenv
618 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200619 - uid
620 - ulimit-n
621 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200622 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100623 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200624 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200625 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200628 - ssl-default-bind-options
629 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200630 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200631 - ssl-default-server-options
632 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100633 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200634 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100635 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100636 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100637 - 51degrees-data-file
638 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200639 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200640 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200641 - wurfl-data-file
642 - wurfl-information-list
643 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200644 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100645 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100646
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100648 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200649 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200650 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200651 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100652 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100653 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100654 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200655 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200656 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200657 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200658 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200659 - noepoll
660 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000661 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200662 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100663 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300664 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000665 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100666 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200667 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200668 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200669 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000670 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000671 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200672 - tune.buffers.limit
673 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200674 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200675 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100676 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200677 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200678 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200679 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100680 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200681 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200682 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100683 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100684 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100685 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100686 - tune.lua.session-timeout
687 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200688 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100689 - tune.maxaccept
690 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200691 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200692 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200693 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100694 - tune.rcvbuf.client
695 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100696 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200697 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100698 - tune.sndbuf.client
699 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100700 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100701 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200702 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100703 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200704 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200705 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100706 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200707 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100708 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200709 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
710 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
711 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100712 - tune.zlib.memlevel
713 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100714
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200715 * Debugging
716 - debug
717 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200718 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200719
720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007213.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722------------------------------------
723
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200724ca-base <dir>
725 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100726 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
727 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
728 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200729
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200730chroot <jail dir>
731 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
732 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
733 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
734 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
735 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100736 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100737
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100738cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
739 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
740 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
741 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
742 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
743 set. These sets have the format
744
745 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
746
747 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100748 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100749 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
750 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100751 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
752 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100753 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100754 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100755 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100756 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100757 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
758 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
759 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
760 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100761
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100762 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
763 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
764 on the machine's word size.
765
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100766 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100767 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
768 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
769 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
770 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
771 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
772 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100773
774 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100775 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
776
777 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
778 # first 4 CPUs
779
780 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
781 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
782 # word size.
783
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100784 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100785 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100786 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
787 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
788 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
789
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100790 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
791 # and so on.
792 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
793 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
794 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
795
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100796 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100797 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
798 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
799 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
800
801 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
802 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
803 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
804
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100805 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
806 # and a thread range.
807 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
808 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
809 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
810
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200811crt-base <dir>
812 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100813 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
814 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200815
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200816daemon
817 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
818 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100819 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
820 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200821
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200822deviceatlas-json-file <path>
823 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100824 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200825
826deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100827 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200828 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
829
830deviceatlas-separator <char>
831 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
832 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
833
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100834deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200835 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
836 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
837 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100838
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900839external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100840 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
841 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100842 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
843 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
844 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
845 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
846 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900847
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200848gid <number>
849 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
850 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
851 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100852 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
853 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200854 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100855
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100856group <group name>
857 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
858 See also "gid" and "user".
859
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100860hard-stop-after <time>
861 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
862
863 Arguments :
864 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
865 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
866 SIGUSR1 signal.
867
868 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
869 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
870 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
871
872 Example:
873 global
874 hard-stop-after 30s
875
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200876h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
877 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
878 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
879 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
880 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500881 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200882 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
883 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
884 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
885 specified in a proxy.
886
887 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
888 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
889 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
890 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
891 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
892 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
893 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
894
895 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
896 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
897 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
898 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
899 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
900
901 Example:
902 global
903 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
904
905 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
906 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
907
908h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
909 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
910 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
911 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
912 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
913 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
914 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
915 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
916 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
917
918 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
919 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
920 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
921
922 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
923 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
924
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100925insecure-fork-wanted
926 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
927 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
928 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
929 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
930 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
931 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
932 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
933 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
934 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
935 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
936 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
937 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
938 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
939 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
940 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
941 disable it.
942
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100943insecure-setuid-wanted
944 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
945 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
946 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
947 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
948 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
949 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
950 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
951 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
952 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
953 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
954 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
955 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
956 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
957 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
958
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100959issuers-chain-path <dir>
960 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
961 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
962 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
963 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
964 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
965 "issuers-chain-path".
966 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
967 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
968 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
969 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
970 will share the chain in memory.
971
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200972log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
973 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100974 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100975 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100976 configured with "log global".
977
978 <address> can be one of:
979
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100980 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100981 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
982 port).
983
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100984 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
985 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
986 port).
987
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100988 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100989 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
990 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100991 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100992
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100993 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
994 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
995 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
996 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
997 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
998 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
999 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1000 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1001 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1002 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1003 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1004 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1005 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1006 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001007 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1008 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001009
1010 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1011 "fd@2", see above.
1012
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001013 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1014 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1015 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1016 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1017 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1018
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001019 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1020 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001021
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001022 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1023 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1024 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1025 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1026 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1027 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1028 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1029 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1030 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1031 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001032 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1033 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001034
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001035 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1036 one of the following :
1037
1038 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1039 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1040
1041 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1042 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1043
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001044 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1045 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1046 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1047 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1048 logger consumes.
1049
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001050 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1051 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1052 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1053 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1054
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001055 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1056 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1057 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1058 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1059 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1060
1061 <sample_size>
1062 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1063 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1064 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1065 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1066 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1067
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001068 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001069
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001070 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1071 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1072 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1073
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001074 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1075 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1076 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1077 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001078
1079 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001080 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1081 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1082 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1083 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1084 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1085 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001086
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001087 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001088
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001089log-send-hostname [<string>]
1090 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1091 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1092 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1093 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1094 the logs.
1095
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001096log-tag <string>
1097 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1098 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1099 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001100 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001101
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001102lua-load <file>
1103 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1104 used multiple times.
1105
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001106lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1107 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1108 variable.
1109 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1110 to "path".
1111
1112 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1113 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1114 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1115 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1116 will be checked earlier.
1117
1118 As an example by specifying the following path:
1119
1120 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1121 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1122
1123 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1124 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1125 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1126 paths if that does not exist either.
1127
1128 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1129 documentation.
1130
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001131master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001132 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1133 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1134 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001135 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001136 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1137 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001138 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1139 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1140 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1141 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1142 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001143
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001144 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001145
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001146mworker-max-reloads <number>
1147 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001148 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001149 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1150 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1151 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1152
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001153nbproc <number>
1154 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1155 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1156 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001157 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1158 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001159 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1160 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001161
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001162nbthread <number>
1163 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001164 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1165 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1166 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1167 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1168 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001169 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1170 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1171 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1172 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1173 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1174 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1175 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001176
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001177pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001178 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001179 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1180 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1181
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001182pp2-never-send-local
1183 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1184 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1185 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1186 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1187 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1188 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1189 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1190 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1191 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1192 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1193 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1194
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001195presetenv <name> <value>
1196 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1197 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1198 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1199 and "unsetenv".
1200
1201resetenv [<name> ...]
1202 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1203 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1204 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1205 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1206 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1207 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1208 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1209 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1210
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001211stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001212 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1213 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1214 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1215 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1216 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1217 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001218 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001219 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1220 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1221 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1222 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001223
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001224server-state-base <directory>
1225 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001226 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1227 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001228
1229server-state-file <file>
1230 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1231 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1232 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1233 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1234 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1235 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1236 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1237 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001238 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1239 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001240
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001241setenv <name> <value>
1242 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1243 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1244 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1245 and "unsetenv".
1246
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001247set-dumpable
1248 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001249 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1250 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1251 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1252 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1253 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1254 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1255 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1256 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1257 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1258 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1259 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1260 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1261 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1262 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1263 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1264 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1265 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001266
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001267ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1268 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1269 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001270 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001271 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001272 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1273 information and recommendations see e.g.
1274 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1275 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1276 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1277 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001278
1279ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1281 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1282 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1283 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1284 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001285 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1286 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1287 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001288 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001289
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001290ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1292 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1293 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1294 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1295 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1296
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001297ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1299 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1300 keyword to see available options.
1301
1302 Example:
1303 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001304 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001305
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001306ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1308 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001309 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001310 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001311 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1312 information and recommendations see e.g.
1313 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1314 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1315 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1316 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1317 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001318
1319ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1320 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1321 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1322 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1323 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1324 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001325 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1326 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1327 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1328 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001329
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001330ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1332 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1333 keyword to see available options.
1334
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001335ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1337 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1338 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001339 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001340 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001341 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1342 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1343 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1344 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001345 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1346 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1347 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1348
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001349ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001350 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1351 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1352
1353 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1354 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1355 optimize the startup time.
1356
1357 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1358 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1359 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1360
1361 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001362 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001363
1364 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1365 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1366 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1367 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1368 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1369 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001370 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001371 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1372
1373 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1374
1375 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1376
1377 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1378 not provided in the PEM file.
1379
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001380 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1381 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1382
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001383 The default behavior is "all".
1384
1385 Example:
1386 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1387 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1388 ssl-load-extra-files none
1389
1390 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1391
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001392ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1393 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1394 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1395 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1396
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001397ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1398 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1399 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1400 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1401 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1402 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1403 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1404 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1405 bits does not need it.
1406
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001407stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1408 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1409 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1410 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001411 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001412 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001413
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001414 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1415 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1416 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001417
1418stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1419 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1420 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001421 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001422
1423stats maxconn <connections>
1424 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1425 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001427uid <number>
1428 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1429 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1430 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1431 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1432
1433ulimit-n <number>
1434 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1435 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1436 option.
1437
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001438unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1439 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1440
1441 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1442 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1443 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1444 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1445 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1446 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1447 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1448 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1449 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1450 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1451
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001452unsetenv [<name> ...]
1453 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1454 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1455 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1456 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1457 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1458 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1459 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1460
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001461user <user name>
1462 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1463 See also "uid" and "group".
1464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001465node <name>
1466 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1467
1468 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1469 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1470 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1471 traffic.
1472
1473description <text>
1474 Add a text that describes the instance.
1475
1476 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1477 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1478 "<" and ">" characters.
1479
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100148051degrees-data-file <file path>
1481 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001482 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001483
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001484 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001485 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1486
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000148751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001488 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1489 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1490 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1491
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001492 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001493 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1494
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200149551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001496 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1497 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1498
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001499 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1500 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1501
150251degrees-cache-size <number>
1503 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1504 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1505 By default, this cache is disabled.
1506
1507 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001508 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1509
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001510wurfl-data-file <file path>
1511 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1512 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1513
1514 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1515 with USE_WURFL=1.
1516
1517wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1518 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1519 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1520 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1521
1522 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1523
1524 Valid WURFL properties are:
1525 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1526
1527 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1528 device.
1529
1530 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1531 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1532
1533 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1534 particular web request.
1535
1536 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1537 used Libwurfl API version.
1538
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001539 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1540 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1541
1542 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1543 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1544
1545 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1546
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001547 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1548 with USE_WURFL=1.
1549
1550wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1551 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1552 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1553
1554 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1555 with USE_WURFL=1.
1556
1557wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1558 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1559 thus before the chroot.
1560
1561 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1562 with USE_WURFL=1.
1563
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001564wurfl-cache-size <size>
1565 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1566 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001567 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001568 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001569
1570 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1571 with USE_WURFL=1.
1572
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001573strict-limits
1574 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1575 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1576 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1577 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1578 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1579 keyword.
1580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015813.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001582-----------------------
1583
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001584busy-polling
1585 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1586 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1587 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1588 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1589 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1590 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1591 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1592 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1593 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1594 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1595 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1596 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1597 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1598 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1599 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1600 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1601 "poll" pollers.
1602
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001603 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1604 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1605 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1606
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001607max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1608 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1609 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1610 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1611 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1612 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1613 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1614 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1615 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1616
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001617maxconn <number>
1618 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1619 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1620 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001621 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1622 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1623 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1624 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001625 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1626 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1627 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1628 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1629 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1630 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001631
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001632maxconnrate <number>
1633 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1634 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1635 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1636 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1637 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1638 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1639 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1640 fairness.
1641
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001642maxcomprate <number>
1643 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001644 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001645 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1646 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1647 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001648 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001649 default value.
1650
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001651maxcompcpuusage <number>
1652 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1653 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1654 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1655 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1656 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1657 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1658 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1659 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1660
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001661maxpipes <number>
1662 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1663 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1664 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1665 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1666 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1667 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1668
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001669maxsessrate <number>
1670 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1671 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1672 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1673 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1674 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1675 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1676 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1677 fairness.
1678
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001679maxsslconn <number>
1680 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1681 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1682 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1683 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1684 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1685 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1686 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001687 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1688 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1689 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1690 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1691 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1692 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1693 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001694
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001695maxsslrate <number>
1696 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1697 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1698 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1699 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1700 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1701 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1702 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1703 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1704 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1705 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1706
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001707maxzlibmem <number>
1708 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1709 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1710 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001711 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1712 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1713 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1714
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001715noepoll
1716 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1717 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001718 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001719
1720nokqueue
1721 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1722 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1723 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1724
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001725noevports
1726 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1727 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1728 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1729 also "nopoll".
1730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001731nopoll
1732 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1733 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001734 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001735 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1736 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001737
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001738nosplice
1739 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001740 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001741 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001742 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001743 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1744 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1745 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1746 "option splice-response".
1747
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001748nogetaddrinfo
1749 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1750 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1751
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001752noreuseport
1753 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1754 command line argument "-dR".
1755
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001756profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1757 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1758 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1759 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1760 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001761 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001762 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1763 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1764 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1765 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1766
1767 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1768 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1769 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1770 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1771 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001772 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1773 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1774 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1775 CLI.
1776
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001777spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001778 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1779 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1780 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1781 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1782 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1783 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001784
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001785ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001786 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001787 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001788 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1789 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1790 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1791 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1792 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001793 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1794 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001795 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1796 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1797 openssl configuration file uses:
1798 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1799
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001800ssl-mode-async
1801 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001802 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001803 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1804 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1805 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001806 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001807 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001808
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001809tune.buffers.limit <number>
1810 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1811 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1812 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1813 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1814 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001815 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001816 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1817 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1818 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1819 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1820 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1821 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1822 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1823 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1824 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1825
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001826tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1827 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1828 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1829 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1830 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1831
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001832tune.bufsize <number>
1833 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1834 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1835 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1836 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1837 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1838 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1839 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001840 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1841 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1842 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001843 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001844 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1845 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1846 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001847
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001848tune.chksize <number>
1849 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1850 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1851 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1852 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1853 checks whenever possible.
1854
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001855tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1856 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1857 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1858 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1859 this value. The default value is 1.
1860
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001861tune.fail-alloc
1862 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1863 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1864 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1865 gracefully.
1866
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001867tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1868 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1869 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1870 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1871 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1872 change it.
1873
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001874tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1875 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001876 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1877 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001878 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1879 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1880 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1881 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1882 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1883
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001884tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1885 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1886 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1887 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1888 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1889 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1890 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1891 recommended not to change this value.
1892
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001893tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1894 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1895 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1896 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1897 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1898 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1899 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1900 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1901
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001902tune.http.cookielen <number>
1903 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1904 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1905 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1906 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1907 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1908 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1909 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1910 to change this value.
1911
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001912tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001913 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1914 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001915 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001916 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001917 configuration directives too.
1918 The default value is 1024.
1919
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001920tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1921 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1922 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1923 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1924 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1925 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1926 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001927 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1928 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1929 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001930
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001931tune.idletimer <timeout>
1932 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1933 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1934 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1935 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1936 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1937 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001938 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001939 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001940 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1941
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001942tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1943 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1944 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1945 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1946 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1947 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1948 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1949 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1950 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1951 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1952
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001953tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1954 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001955 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001956 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1957 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001958 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001959 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1960 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1961
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001962tune.lua.maxmem
1963 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1964 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1965 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1966 memory.
1967
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001968tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1969 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001970 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1971 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001972 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001973
1974tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1975 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1976 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1977 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1978 check servers.
1979
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001980tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1981 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1982 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1983 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001984 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001985
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001986tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001987 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1988 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1989 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1990 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1991 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1992 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1993 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1994 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1995 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1996 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001997
1998tune.maxpollevents <number>
1999 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2000 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2001 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2002 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2003 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2004
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002005tune.maxrewrite <number>
2006 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2007 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2008 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2009 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2010 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2011 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2012 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2013 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2014 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2015 bufsize.
2016
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002017tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2018 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2019 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2020 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2021 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2022 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2023 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2024 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2025 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2026 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002027 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2028 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002029 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2030 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2031 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2032 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2033 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2034 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2035 setting this parameter to 0.
2036
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002037tune.pipesize <number>
2038 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2039 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2040 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2041 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2042 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2043 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2044
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002045tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2046 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2047 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2048 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2049 default is 20.
2050
2051tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2052 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2053 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2054 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2055 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2056 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2057 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002058 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002059
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002060tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2061tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2062 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2063 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2064 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002065 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002066 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002067 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2068 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2069
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002070tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002071 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002072 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2073 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2074 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2075 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2076
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002077tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002078 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002079 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
2080 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
2081
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002082tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2083tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2084 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2085 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2086 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002087 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002088 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002089 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2090 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2091 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2092 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2093 notifying haproxy again.
2094
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002095tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002096 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2097 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2098 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002099 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002100 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002101 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002102 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2103 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2104 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002105 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2106 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002107
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002108tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002109 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002110 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2111 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2112 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2113 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2114 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2115
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002116tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2117 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002118 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002119 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2120 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2121 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2122 being used for too long.
2123
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002124tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2125 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2126 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2127 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2128 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2129 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2130 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2131 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2132 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2133 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2134 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002135 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002136 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002137
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002138tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2139 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2140 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2141 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2142 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002143 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002144 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2145 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002146 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2147 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002148
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002149tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2150 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2151 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2152 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2153 1000 entries.
2154
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002155tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2156 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2157 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2158 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2159
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002160tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002161tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002162tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2163tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2164tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002165 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2166 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2167 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2168 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2169 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2170 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2171 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2172 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002173
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002174 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2175 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2176 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2177 all available space is consumed.
2178 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2179 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2180 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002181
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002182tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2183 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002184 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002185 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002186 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002187 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2188
2189tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2190 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2191 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002192 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2193 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002194
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021953.3. Debugging
2196--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002197
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002198debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002199 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2200 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2201 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2202 system startup.
2203
2204quiet
2205 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2206 line argument "-q".
2207
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002208zero-warning
2209 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2210 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2211 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2212 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2213 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2214 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2215
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002216
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022173.4. Userlists
2218--------------
2219It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2220http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2221it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2222
2223userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002224 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002225 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2226
2227group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002228 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002229 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2230 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2231
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002232user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2233 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002234 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2235 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002236 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2237 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2238 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2239 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002240
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002241 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2242 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2243 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2244 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2245 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2246 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2247 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2248 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2249 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002250
2251 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002252 userlist L1
2253 group G1 users tiger,scott
2254 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002255
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002256 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2257 user scott insecure-password elgato
2258 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002259
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002260 userlist L2
2261 group G1
2262 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002263
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002264 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2265 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2266 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002267
2268 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002269
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002270
22713.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002272----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002273It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2274several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2275instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2276values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2277automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2278In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2279using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2280tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2281reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2282Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2283that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2284each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002285
2286peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002287 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002288 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2289
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002290bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2291 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2292 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2293
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002294disabled
2295 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2296 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2297 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2298
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002299default-bind [param*]
2300 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2301
2302default-server [param*]
2303 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2304
2305 Arguments:
2306 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2307 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2308 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2309 details.
2310
2311
2312 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2313
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002314enable
2315 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2316
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002317log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2318 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2319 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2320 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2321 more details.
2322
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002323peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002324 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2325 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
2326 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
2327 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
2328 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
2329 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
2330
2331 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2332 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2333
2334 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
2335 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
2336 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
2337 across all peers.
2338
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002339 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2340 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002341
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002342 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2343 "server" keyword explanation below).
2344
2345server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002346 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002347 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2348 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2349 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2350 of this "peers" section).
2351 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2352
2353
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002354 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002355 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002356 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002357 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2358 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2359 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002360
2361 backend mybackend
2362 mode tcp
2363 balance roundrobin
2364 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2365 stick on src
2366
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002367 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2368 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002369
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002370 Example:
2371 peers mypeers
2372 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2373 default-server ssl verify none
2374 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2375 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002376
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002377
2378table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2379 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2380
2381 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2382 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002383 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002384 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2385 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2386 "stick-table" keyword).
2387
2388 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2389 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2390 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2391 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2392 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2393 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2394 of the stick-table name as follows:
2395
2396 peers mypeers
2397 peer A ...
2398 peer B ...
2399 table t1 ...
2400
2401 frontend fe1
2402 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2403
2404 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2405 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2406
2407 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2408 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2409 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2410 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2411 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2412 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2413 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2414
2415 peers mypeers
2416 peer A ...
2417 peer B ...
2418 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2419
2420 backend t1
2421 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2422
2423 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2424 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2425 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2426
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024273.6. Mailers
2428------------
2429It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2430If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2431in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2432
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002433mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002434 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2435 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2436
2437mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2438 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2439
2440 Example:
2441 mailers mymailers
2442 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2443 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2444
2445 backend mybackend
2446 mode tcp
2447 balance roundrobin
2448
2449 email-alert mailers mymailers
2450 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2451 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2452
2453 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2454 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2455
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002456timeout mail <time>
2457 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2458 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2459 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2460 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2461
2462 Example:
2463 mailers mymailers
2464 timeout mail 20s
2465 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002466
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020024673.7. Programs
2468-------------
2469In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2470master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2471managed the same way as the workers.
2472
2473During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2474sequence as a worker:
2475
2476 - the master is re-executed
2477 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2478 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2479 instance of the program
2480
2481During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2482
2483program <name>
2484 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2485 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2486 the management guide).
2487
2488command <command> [arguments*]
2489 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2490 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2491 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2492 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2493
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002494user <user name>
2495 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2496 See also "group".
2497
2498group <group name>
2499 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2500 See also "user".
2501
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002502option start-on-reload
2503no option start-on-reload
2504 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2505 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2506 program section.
2507
2508
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010025093.8. HTTP-errors
2510----------------
2511
2512It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2513imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2514several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2515
2516http-errors <name>
2517 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2518 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2519
2520errorfile <code> <file>
2521 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2522
2523 Arguments :
2524 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002525 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2526 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002527
2528 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2529 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2530 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2531 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2532 before any chroot is performed.
2533
2534 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2535
2536 Example:
2537 http-errors website-1
2538 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2539 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2540 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2541
2542 http-errors website-2
2543 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2544 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2545 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2546
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020025473.9. Rings
2548----------
2549
2550It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2551servers or traces.
2552
2553ring <ringname>
2554 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2555
2556description <text>
2557 The descritpition is an optional description string of the ring. It will
2558 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2559
2560format <format>
2561 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2562
2563 Arguments:
2564 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2565 one of the following :
2566
2567 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2568 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2569 designed to be used with a local log server.
2570
2571 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2572 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2573 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2574 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2575 is the default.
2576
2577 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2578 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2579
2580 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2581 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2582
2583 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2584 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2585 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2586 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2587 logger consumes.
2588
2589 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2590 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2591 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2592 used with a local log server.
2593
2594maxlen <length>
2595 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2596 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2597 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2598
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002599server <name> <address> [param*]
2600 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2601 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2602 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2603 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2604 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2605 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2606 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2607 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2608 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002609 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2610 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002611
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002612size <size>
2613 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2614 set to BUFSIZE.
2615
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002616timeout connect <timeout>
2617 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2618
2619 Arguments :
2620 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2621 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2622 as explained at the top of this document.
2623
2624timeout server <timeout>
2625 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2626
2627 Arguments :
2628 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2629 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2630 as explained at the top of this document.
2631
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002632 Example:
2633 global
2634 log ring@myring local7
2635
2636 ring myring
2637 description "My local buffer"
2638 format rfc3164
2639 maxlen 1200
2640 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002641 timeout connect 5s
2642 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002643 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002644
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002645
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026464. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002647----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002648
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002649Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002650 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002651 - frontend <name>
2652 - backend <name>
2653 - listen <name>
2654
2655A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2656its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2657section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002658section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002659
2660A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2661connections.
2662
2663A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2664to forward incoming connections.
2665
2666A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2667parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002669All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2670'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2671case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2672
2673Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2674logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2675proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2676However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2677name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2678
2679Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2680and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002681bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002682protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2683modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2684arbitrary criteria.
2685
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002686In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2687a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002688the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002689
2690 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2691 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2692 between responses and new requests.
2693
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002694 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2695 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2696 client-facing connection remains open.
2697
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002698 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2699 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002700
2701The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2702frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2703following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002704weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002705
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002706 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002707
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002708 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2709 ----+-----+-----+----
2710 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2711 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002712 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2713 ----+-----+-----+----
2714 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002715
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002716
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002717
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027184.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2719--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002720
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002721The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2722limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2723they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2724limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002725marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002726option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002727and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2728with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2729specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002730
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002731
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002732 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2733------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2734acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002735backlog X X X -
2736balance X - X X
2737bind - X X -
2738bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002739capture cookie - X X -
2740capture request header - X X -
2741capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002742compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002743cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002744declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002745default-server X - X X
2746default_backend X X X -
2747description - X X X
2748disabled X X X X
2749dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002750email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002751email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002752email-alert mailers X X X X
2753email-alert myhostname X X X X
2754email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002755enabled X X X X
2756errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002757errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002758errorloc X X X X
2759errorloc302 X X X X
2760-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2761errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002762force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002763filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002764fullconn X - X X
2765grace X X X X
2766hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002767http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002768http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002769http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002770http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002771http-check expect X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002772http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002773http-check set-var X - X X
2774http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002775http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002776http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002777http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002778http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002779http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002780id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002781ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002782load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002783log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002784log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002785log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002786log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002787max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002788maxconn X X X -
2789mode X X X X
2790monitor fail - X X -
2791monitor-net X X X -
2792monitor-uri X X X -
2793option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2794option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2795option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2796option allbackups (*) X - X X
2797option checkcache (*) X - X X
2798option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2799option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002800option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002801option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2802option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002803-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2804option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002805option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2806option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002807option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002808option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002809option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002810option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002811option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002812option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2813option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2814option httpchk X - X X
2815option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002816option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002817option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002818option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002819option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002820option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002821option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2822option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2823option logasap (*) X X X -
2824option mysql-check X - X X
2825option nolinger (*) X X X X
2826option originalto X X X X
2827option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002828option pgsql-check X - X X
2829option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002830option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002831option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002832option smtpchk X - X X
2833option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2834option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2835option splice-request (*) X X X X
2836option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002837option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002838option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2839option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2840-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002841option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002842option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2843option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2844option tcpka X X X X
2845option tcplog X X X X
2846option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002847external-check command X - X X
2848external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002849persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2850rate-limit sessions X X X -
2851redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002852-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002853retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002854retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002855server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002856server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002857server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002858source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002859stats admin - X X X
2860stats auth X X X X
2861stats enable X X X X
2862stats hide-version X X X X
2863stats http-request - X X X
2864stats realm X X X X
2865stats refresh X X X X
2866stats scope X X X X
2867stats show-desc X X X X
2868stats show-legends X X X X
2869stats show-node X X X X
2870stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002871-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2872stick match - - X X
2873stick on - - X X
2874stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002875stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002876stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002877tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002878tcp-check connect X - X X
2879tcp-check expect X - X X
2880tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002881tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002882tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002883tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002884tcp-check set-var X - X X
2885tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002886tcp-request connection - X X -
2887tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002888tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002889tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002890tcp-response content - - X X
2891tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002892timeout check X - X X
2893timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002894timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002895timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002896timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2897timeout http-request X X X X
2898timeout queue X - X X
2899timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002900timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002901timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002902timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002903transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002904unique-id-format X X X -
2905unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002906use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002907use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002908use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002909------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2910 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002911
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029134.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2914---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002915
2916This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2917
2918
2919acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2920 Declare or complete an access list.
2921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2922 no | yes | yes | yes
2923 Example:
2924 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2925 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2926 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2927
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002928 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002929
2930
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002931backlog <conns>
2932 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2934 yes | yes | yes | no
2935 Arguments :
2936 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2937 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002938 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002939
2940 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2941 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2942 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2943 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2944 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2945 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2946 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2947 backlog parameter.
2948
2949 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2950 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2951 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2952
2953 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2954
2955
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002956balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002957balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002958 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2960 yes | no | yes | yes
2961 Arguments :
2962 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2963 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2964 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2965 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2966
2967 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2968 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2969 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2970 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002971 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002972 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002973 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2974 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2975 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2976 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2977 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2978 it, so that you don't worry.
2979
2980 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2981 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2982 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2983 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2984 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2985 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2986 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2987 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002988
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002989 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2990 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2991 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2992 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2993 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2994 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2995 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2996 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2997
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002998 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002999 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003000 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3001 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003002 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003003 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3004 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3005 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3006 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3007 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003008 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3009 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3010 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3011 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3012 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3013 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003014
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003015 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3016 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3017 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3018 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3019 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3020 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3021 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3022 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003023 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003024 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003025 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3026 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3027 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003028
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003029 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3030 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3031 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3032 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3033 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3034 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3035 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3036 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3037 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3038 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3039 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3040 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003041
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003042 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003043 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3044 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3045 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3046 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3047 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3048 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3049 URIs start with a leading "/".
3050
3051 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3052 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3053 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3054 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3055
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003056 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003057 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3058
3059 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003060 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3061 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003062 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3063 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3064 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3065 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003066 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003067 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3068 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003069
3070 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3071 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3072 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3073 server will receive the request.
3074
3075 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3076 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3077 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3078 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3079 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003080 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3081 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3082 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003084 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3085 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3086 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3087 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3088 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003090 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003091 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3092 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3093 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3094
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003095 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3096 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3097 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3098
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003099 random
3100 random(<draws>)
3101 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003102 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3103 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3104 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3105 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003106 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3107 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3108 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3109 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3110 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3111 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3112 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3113 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3114 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3115 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3116 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3117 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3118 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3119 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3120 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3121 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3122 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3123 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3124 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3125 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003126
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003127 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003128 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003129 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3130 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3131 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3132 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3133 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3134 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003135 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003136 used instead.
3137
3138 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3139 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3140 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3141 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3142
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003143 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3144 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3145 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3146
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003147 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003148
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003149 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003150 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3151 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003152
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003153 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3154 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3155 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003156
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003157 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003158 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003159 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3160 NTLM relies on.
3161
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003162 Examples :
3163 balance roundrobin
3164 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003165 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003166 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3167 balance hdr(host)
3168 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003169
3170 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3171 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3172
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003173 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003174 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3175 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3176 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003177 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003178
3179 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3180 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3181 defaults to 16 kB.
3182
3183 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3184 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3185
3186 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3187 Round Robin.
3188
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003189 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003190 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3191 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3192 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3193
3194 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3195
3196 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003197 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003198 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3199 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3200 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003201
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003202 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003203
3204
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003205bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3206bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003207 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3208 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3209 no | yes | yes | no
3210 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003211 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3212 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3213 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3214 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003215 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003216 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3217 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3218 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3219 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3220 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3221 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3222 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003223 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3224 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3225 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3226 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3227 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3228 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3229 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003230 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3231 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3232 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003233 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3234 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3235 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3236 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003237 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3238 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3239 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003240
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003241 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3242 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003243 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3244 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3245 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003246 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3247 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3248 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3249 the range.
3250
3251 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3252 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3253 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3254 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3255 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3256 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3257 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003258 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003259 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003260
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003261 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003262 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003263 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3264 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3265 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3266 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3267 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3268 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3269
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003270 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3271 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3272 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3273 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3276 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3277 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3278 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3279 in a frontend.
3280
3281 Example :
3282 listen http_proxy
3283 bind :80,:443
3284 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003285 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003286
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003287 listen http_https_proxy
3288 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003289 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003290
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003291 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3292 bind ipv6@:80
3293 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3294 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3295
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003296 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003297 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003298
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003299 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3300 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3301 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3302 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3303 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3304
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003305 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003306 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003307
3308
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003309bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003310 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3312 yes | yes | yes | yes
3313 Arguments :
3314 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3315 may be used to override a default value.
3316
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003317 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003318 option may be combined with other numbers.
3319
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003320 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003321 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3322 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3323 missing from all processes.
3324
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003325 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003326 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003327 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3328 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3329 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3330 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3331 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003332 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003333
3334 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3335 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3336 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3337 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3338 and 'even' instances.
3339
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003340 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3341 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3342 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3343 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003344
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003345 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3346 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3347
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003348 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3349 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3350 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3351
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003352 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3353 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3354
3355 Example :
3356 listen app_ip1
3357 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003358 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003359
3360 listen app_ip2
3361 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003362 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003363
3364 listen management
3365 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003366 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003367
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003368 listen management
3369 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3370 bind-process 1-4
3371
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003372 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003373
3374
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003375capture cookie <name> len <length>
3376 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3378 no | yes | yes | no
3379 Arguments :
3380 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3381 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3382 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3383 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003384 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003385
3386 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3387 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3388 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3389 right if it exceeds <length>.
3390
3391 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3392 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3393 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3394 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3395
3396 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3397 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3398 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3399
3400 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3401 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3402 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003403 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3404 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3405 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003406
3407 Example:
3408 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3409
3410 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003411 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003412
3413
3414capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003415 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3417 no | yes | yes | no
3418 Arguments :
3419 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003420 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003421 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3422 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3423 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3424
3425 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3426 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3427 it exceeds <length>.
3428
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003429 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003430 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3431 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003432 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3433 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3434 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3435 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003436 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003437 environments to find where the request came from.
3438
3439 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3440 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3441 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3442 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003443
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003444 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3445 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3446 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3447 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3448 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003449
3450 Example:
3451 capture request header Host len 15
3452 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003453 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003454
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003455 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003456 about logging.
3457
3458
3459capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003460 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3462 no | yes | yes | no
3463 Arguments :
3464 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003465 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3467 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3468 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3469
3470 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3471 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3472 it exceeds <length>.
3473
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003474 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003475 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3476 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3477 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003478 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3479 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3480 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3481 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003482
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003483 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3484 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3485 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3486 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3487 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003488
3489 Example:
3490 capture response header Content-length len 9
3491 capture response header Location len 15
3492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003493 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003494 about logging.
3495
3496
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003497compression algo <algorithm> ...
3498compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003499compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003500 Enable HTTP compression.
3501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3502 yes | yes | yes | yes
3503 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003504 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3505 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3506 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3507
3508 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003509 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3510 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3511 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003512
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003513 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003514 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003515
3516 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3517 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3518 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3519 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3520 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003521 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003522
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003523 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3524 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3525 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3526 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3527 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3528 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3529 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003530 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003531
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003532 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003533 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003534 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3535 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3536 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3537 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3538 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003539
3540 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3541 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3542 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3543 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3544 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003545 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3546 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3547 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3548 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3549 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003550 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3551 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003552
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003553 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003554 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3555 "Accept-Encoding" header
3556 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003557 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003558 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3559 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3560 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3561 "multipart"
3562 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3563 header
3564 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3565 and later
3566 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3567 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003568 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003569
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003570 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003571
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003572 Examples :
3573 compression algo gzip
3574 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003575
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003576
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003577cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003578 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3579 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003580 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003581 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3583 yes | no | yes | yes
3584 Arguments :
3585 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3586 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3587 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3588 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3589 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3590 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003591 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003592 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3593 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3594
3595 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3596 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3597 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3598 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3599 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3600 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003601 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3602 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003603 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003604 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3605 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003606
3607 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003608 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003609
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003610 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003611 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003612 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003613 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003614 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3615 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3616 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3617 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3618 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3619 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3620 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003621
3622 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3623 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3624 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3625 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3626 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3627 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3628 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3629 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3630 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003631 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003632 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3633 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3634 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003635
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003636 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3637 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3638 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003639 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3640 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3641 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3642 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003643 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3644 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3645 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003646
3647 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3648 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3649 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3650 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3651 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3652 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3653 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3654 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3655 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3656
3657 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3658 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3659 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3660 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3661 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3662 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3663 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3664 persistence cookie in the cache.
3665 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3666
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003667 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3668 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3669 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3670 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3671 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003672 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003673 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3674 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3675 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3676 they logout.
3677
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003678 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3679 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3680 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3681 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3682
3683 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3684 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3685 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3686 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3687 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3688 this attribute.
3689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003690 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003691 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003692 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3693 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3694 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3695 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3696 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3697 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003698
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003699 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3700 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3701 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3702 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3703 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3704 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3705 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3706 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003707 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003708 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3709 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3710 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3711 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3712 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3713 the site.
3714
3715 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3716 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3717 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3718 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3719 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3720 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3721 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3722 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3723 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3724 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3725 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3726 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3727 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003728 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003729 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3730 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3731
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003732 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3733 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3734 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3735 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3736 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3737 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3738
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003739 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3740 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3741 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3742 repeated.
3743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003744 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3745 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3746 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3747 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003749 Examples :
3750 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3751 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3752 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003753 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003754
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003755 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003756
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003757
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003758declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3759 Declares a capture slot.
3760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3761 no | yes | yes | no
3762 Arguments:
3763 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3764
3765 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3766 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3767 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3768 for use in the response.
3769
3770 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003771 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003772 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3773
3774
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003775default-server [param*]
3776 Change default options for a server in a backend
3777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3778 yes | no | yes | yes
3779 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003780 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3781 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3782 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3783 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003784
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003785 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003786 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3787
3788 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003789
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003790
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003791default_backend <backend>
3792 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3794 yes | yes | yes | no
3795 Arguments :
3796 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3797
3798 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3799 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3800 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3801 will catch all undetermined requests.
3802
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003803 Example :
3804
3805 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3806 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3807 default_backend dynamic
3808
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003809 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003810
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003811
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003812description <string>
3813 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3815 no | yes | yes | yes
3816 Arguments : string
3817
3818 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3819 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3820 it describes.
3821 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3822
3823
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003824disabled
3825 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3827 yes | yes | yes | yes
3828 Arguments : none
3829
3830 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3831 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3832 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3833 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3834 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3835 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3836 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3837
3838 See also : "enabled"
3839
3840
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003841dispatch <address>:<port>
3842 Set a default server address
3843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3844 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003845 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003846
3847 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3848 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3849 during start-up.
3850
3851 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3852 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3853 possible with normal servers.
3854
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003855 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003856 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3857 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3858 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3859 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3860
3861 See also : "server"
3862
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003863
3864dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3865 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3867 yes | no | yes | yes
3868 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3869
3870 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003871 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003872 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3873 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003874 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003875 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003876
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003877enabled
3878 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3880 yes | yes | yes | yes
3881 Arguments : none
3882
3883 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3884 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3885
3886 See also : "disabled"
3887
3888
3889errorfile <code> <file>
3890 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3892 yes | yes | yes | yes
3893 Arguments :
3894 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003895 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
3896 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003897
3898 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003899 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003900 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003901 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3902 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003903
3904 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3905 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3906 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3907
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003908 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3909
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02003910 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
3911 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
3912 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
3913 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
3914 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
3915 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
3916 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
3917 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
3918 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003919
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003920 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3921 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3922 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003923 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003924 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3925
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003926 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003927
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003928 Example :
3929 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003930 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003931 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3932 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3933
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003934
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003935errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3936 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3937 section.
3938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3939 yes | yes | yes | yes
3940 Arguments :
3941 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3942
3943 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003944 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
3945 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003946
3947 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3948 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3949 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3950 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3951 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3952 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3953 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3954
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003955 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
3956 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003957
3958 Example :
3959 errorfiles generic
3960 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3961
3962
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003963errorloc <code> <url>
3964errorloc302 <code> <url>
3965 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3967 yes | yes | yes | yes
3968 Arguments :
3969 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003970 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
3971 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003972
3973 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3974 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3975 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3976 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003977 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003978
3979 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3980 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3981 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3982
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003983 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3984
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003985 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3986 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3987 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3988 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003989 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003990 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3991 request.
3992
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003993 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003994
3995
3996errorloc303 <code> <url>
3997 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3999 yes | yes | yes | yes
4000 Arguments :
4001 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004002 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
4003 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004004
4005 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4006 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4007 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4008 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004009 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004010
4011 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4012 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4013 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4014
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004015 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4016
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004017 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4018 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4019 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4020 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004021 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004022
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004023 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004024
4025
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004026email-alert from <emailaddr>
4027 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004028 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004029 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4030 yes | yes | yes | yes
4031
4032 Arguments :
4033
4034 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4035
4036 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4037 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4038
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004039 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004040 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4041 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004042
4043
4044email-alert level <level>
4045 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4046 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4047 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4048 yes | yes | yes | yes
4049
4050 Arguments :
4051
4052 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4053 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4054 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4055
4056 By default level is alert
4057
4058 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4059 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4060 for the proxy.
4061
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004062 Alerts are sent when :
4063
4064 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4065 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4066 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4067 is notice or lower
4068 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4069 and a health check status update occurs
4070
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004071 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4072 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004073 section 3.6 about mailers.
4074
4075
4076email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4077 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4079 yes | yes | yes | yes
4080
4081 Arguments :
4082
4083 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4084
4085 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4086 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4087
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004088 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4089 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004090
4091
4092email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4093 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4094 mailers.
4095 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4096 yes | yes | yes | yes
4097
4098 Arguments :
4099
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004100 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004101
4102 By default the systems hostname is used.
4103
4104 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4105 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4106 for the proxy.
4107
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004108 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4109 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004110
4111
4112email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004113 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004114 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4115 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4116 yes | yes | yes | yes
4117
4118 Arguments :
4119
4120 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4121
4122 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4123 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4124
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004125 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004126 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4127
4128
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004129force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4130 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4131 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004132 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004133
4134 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4135 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4136 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4137 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4138 marked down for maintenance operations.
4139
4140 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4141 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4142 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4143 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4144 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4145 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4146 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4147 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4148 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4149
4150 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4151 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4152 is used.
4153
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004154 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004155 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004156
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004157
4158filter <name> [param*]
4159 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4161 no | yes | yes | yes
4162 Arguments :
4163 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4164 referenced in section 9.
4165
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004166 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004167 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004168 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4169 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004170
4171 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4172 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4173
4174 Example:
4175 listen
4176 bind *:80
4177
4178 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4179 filter compression
4180 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4181
4182 compression algo gzip
4183 compression offload
4184
4185 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4186
4187 See also : section 9.
4188
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004189
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004190fullconn <conns>
4191 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4193 yes | no | yes | yes
4194 Arguments :
4195 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4196 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4197
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004198 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004199 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004200 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004201 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4202 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4203 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4204 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4205 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004206 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004207
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004208 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4209 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004210 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4211 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4212 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004213
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004214 Example :
4215 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4216 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4217 # connections.
4218 backend dynamic
4219 fullconn 10000
4220 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4221 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4222
4223 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4224
4225
4226grace <time>
4227 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004229 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004230 Arguments :
4231 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4232 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4233 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4234
4235 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4236 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004237 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004238 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4239
4240 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4241 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4242 simplify it.
4243
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004244
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004245hash-balance-factor <factor>
4246 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4248 yes | no | no | yes
4249 Arguments :
4250 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4251 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004252 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004253
4254 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4255 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4256 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4257 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4258 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4259 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4260 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4261
4262 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4263 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4264 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4265 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4266 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4267
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004268 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4269 consistent hashing mechanism.
4270
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004271 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4272
4273
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004274hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004275 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4277 yes | no | yes | yes
4278 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004279 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4280 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004281
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004282 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4283 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4284 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4285 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4286 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4287 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4288 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4289 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4290 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4291 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004292
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004293 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4294 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4295 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4296 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4297 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4298 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4299 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4300 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4301 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4302 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4303 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4304 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4305 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004306 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4307 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004308
4309 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4310
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004311 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004312 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4313 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4314 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004315 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4316 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4317 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004318
4319 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4320 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004321 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4322 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4323 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4324 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4325
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004326 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4327 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4328 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4329 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4330 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4331 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4332 parameter.
4333
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004334 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4335 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4336 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4337 used on strings.
4338
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004339 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4340
4341 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4342 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4343 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4344 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4345 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4346 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4347 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4348 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4349 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4350 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4351 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4352 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004353
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004354 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4355 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4356 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004357
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004358 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004359
4360
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004361http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4362 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4363 ones).
4364
4365 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4366 no | yes | yes | yes
4367
4368 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4369 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4370 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4371 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4372 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4373 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4374
4375 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4376 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4377 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4378
4379 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4380 below.
4381
4382 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4383 instance.
4384
4385 Example:
4386 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4387 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4388 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4389
4390http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4391
4392 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4393 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4394 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4395 example, or to pass some internal information.
4396 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4397 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4398 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4399
4400http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4401
4402 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4403 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4404
4405http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4406
4407 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4408
4409http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4410 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4411
4412 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4413
4414 Example:
4415 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4416
4417 # applied to:
4418 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4419
4420 # outputs:
4421 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4422
4423 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4424
4425http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4426 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4427
4428 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4429
4430 Example:
4431 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4432
4433 # applied to:
4434 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4435
4436 # outputs:
4437 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4438
4439http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4440
4441 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4442 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4443 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4444
4445http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4446 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4447
4448 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4449 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4450 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4451 fallback.
4452
4453 Example:
4454 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4455 http-response set-status 431
4456 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4457 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4458
4459http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4460
4461 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4462 inline.
4463
4464 Arguments:
4465 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4466 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4467 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4468 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4469 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4470 (request and response)
4471 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4472 processing
4473 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4474 processing
4475 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4476 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4477 and '_'.
4478
4479 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4480 followed by some converters.
4481
4482 Example:
4483 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4484
4485http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4486
4487 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4488 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4489 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4490 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4491 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004492 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004493 processing.
4494
4495 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4496 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4497 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4498 rules evaluation.
4499
4500http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4501
4502 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4503 details about <var-name>.
4504
4505 Example:
4506 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4507
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004508
4509http-check comment <string>
4510 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4511 it fails.
4512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4513 yes | no | yes | yes
4514
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004515 Arguments :
4516 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4517 rule fails.
4518
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004519 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4520 user-friendly error reporting.
4521
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004522 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4523 "http-check expect".
4524
4525
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004526http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4527 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004528 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004529 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4531 yes | no | yes | yes
4532
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004533 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004534 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4535
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004536 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4537 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4538
4539 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4540 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4541 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4542 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4543
4544 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4545
4546 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4547
4548 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4549
4550 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4551
4552 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4553
4554 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4555 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4556 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4557 is used.
4558
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004559 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4560 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4561 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4562 haproxy -vv.
4563
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004564 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4565
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004566 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4567 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4568 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4569 different ports or with different servers.
4570
4571 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4572 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4573 the port with a "http-check connect".
4574
4575 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4576 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4577 do.
4578
4579 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4580 unset-var or comment rules.
4581
4582 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004583 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4584 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4585 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4586 option httpchk
4587
4588 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004589 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004590 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004591 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004592 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004593 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004594
4595 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4596
4597 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004598
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004599
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004600http-check disable-on-404
4601 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004603 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004604 Arguments : none
4605
4606 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4607 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4608 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4609 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4610 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4611 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4612 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4613 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004614 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4615 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4616 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4617
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004618 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004619
4620
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004621http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004622 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4623 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4624 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004625 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004627 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004628
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004629 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004630 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4631
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004632 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4633 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4634 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4635 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4636 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4637 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4638 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4639 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4640 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4641 result is always conclusive.
4642
4643 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4644 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4645 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004646 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4647 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4648 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4649 example 404 with disable-on-404
4650 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4651 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4652 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004653
4654 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4655 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004656 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4657 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4658 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4659 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4660 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4661 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004662
4663 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4664 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004665 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4666 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4667 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4668 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004669 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4670
4671 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4672 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4673 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4674 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4675
4676 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4677 informational message reported in logs if an error
4678 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4679 log-format string.
4680
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004681 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004682 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4683 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004684 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4685 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4686 details on the supported keywords.
4687
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004688 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4689 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4690 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4691 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004692
4693 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4694 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4695 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4696 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4697 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4698
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004699 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4700 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4701 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4702 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4703 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4704 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4705 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004706
4707 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004708 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004709 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4710 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4711 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4712 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4713
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004714 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4715 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004716 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4717 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4718 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4719 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4720 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4721 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4722 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4723 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004724 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4725 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4726 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4727 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4728 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4729 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4730 insensitive on the header names.
4731
4732 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4733 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4734 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4735 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4736 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4737 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004738
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004739 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004740 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004741 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4742 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4743 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4744 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4745 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004746 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004747 trace).
4748
4749 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004750 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004751 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4752 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4753 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4754 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4755 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004756 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004757
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004758 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4759 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4760 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4761 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4762 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4763 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4764
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004765 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4766 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4767 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4768 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4769 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4770 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4771 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4772 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4773
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004774 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4775 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4776 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4777 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4778 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004779
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004780 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4781 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4782
4783 Examples :
4784 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004785 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004786
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004787 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4788 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4789
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004790 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004791 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004792
4793 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004794 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004795
4796 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004797 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004798
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004799 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004800 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004801
4802
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004803http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004804 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
4805 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004806 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4807 health checks.
4808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4809 yes | no | yes | yes
4810 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004811 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4812
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004813 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4814 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4815 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4816 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4817 to invent non-standard ones.
4818
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004819 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4820 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
4821 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
4822 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4823
4824 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4825 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
4826 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4827 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004828
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004829 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004830 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4831 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4832 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4833 to add it.
4834
4835 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4836 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4837 to the log-format rules.
4838
4839 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4840 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4841 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004842
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004843 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
4844 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4845 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
4846 request.
4847
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004848 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4849 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4850 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004851 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4852 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4853 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4854 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004855 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4856 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4857 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4858
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004859 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4860 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004861 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4862 so, it will be ignored.
4863
4864 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4865 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4866 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4867 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4868 configured request authority.
4869
4870 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4871 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004872
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004873 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004874
4875
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004876http-check send-state
4877 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4879 yes | no | yes | yes
4880 Arguments : none
4881
4882 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4883 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4884 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4885 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4886 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4887
4888 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4889 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4890 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4891 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4892 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004893 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4894 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4895 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4896
4897 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4898 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4899 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4900
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004901 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4902 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4903 checked in multiple backends.
4904
4905 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4906 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4907
4908 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4909 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4910 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4911 one fails.
4912
4913 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4914 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4915 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4916
4917 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4918 server's queue.
4919
4920 Example of a header received by the application server :
4921 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4922 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4923
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004924 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4925 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004926
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004927
4928http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004929 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004930 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4931 yes | no | yes | yes
4932
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004933 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004934 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4935 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4936 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4937 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4938 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4939 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4940 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4941 and '-'.
4942
4943 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4944
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004945 Examples :
4946 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004947
4948
4949http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004950 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004951 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4952 yes | no | yes | yes
4953
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004954 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004955 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4956 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4957 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4958 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4959 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4960 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4961 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4962 and '-'.
4963
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004964 Examples :
4965 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004966
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004967
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004968http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
4969 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
4970 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
4971 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
4972 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
4973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4974 yes | yes | yes | yes
4975 Arguments :
4976 staus <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
4977 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004978 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 425, 429,
4979 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004980
4981 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
4982 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
4983 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
4984 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
4985
4986 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
4987 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
4988 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
4989 a frontend, the default error message is used.
4990
4991 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
4992 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
4993 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
4994 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
4995 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
4996 chroot is performed.
4997
4998 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
4999 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5000 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5001 considered.
5002
5003 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5004 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5005 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5006 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5007 considered as a raw string.
5008
5009 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5010 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5011 "content-type".
5012
5013 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5014 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5015 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5016 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5017 evaluated as a log-format string.
5018
5019 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5020 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5021 argument to "content-type".
5022
5023 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5024 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5025 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5026 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5027
5028 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5029 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5030 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5031 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5032 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5033 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5034 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5035 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5036
5037 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5038 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5039 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5040
5041 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5042 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5043
5044
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005045http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005046 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5047
5048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5049 no | yes | yes | yes
5050
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005051 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5052 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5053 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5054 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5055 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005057 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5058 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005059
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005060 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005061
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005062 Example:
5063 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5064 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5065 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005066
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005067 http-request allow if nagios
5068 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5069 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5070 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005072 Example:
5073 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5074 acl add path /addacl
5075 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005076
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005077 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005079 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5080 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005082 Example:
5083 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5084 acl setmap path /setmap
5085 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005087 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005089 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5090 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005092 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5093 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005094
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005095http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005097 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5098 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5099 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5100 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5101 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5102 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5103 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5104 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005106http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005108 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5109 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5110 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5111 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5112 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5113 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5114 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5115 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005116
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005117http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005119 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5120 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005121
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005123http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005124
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005125 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5126 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5127 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5128 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5129 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005130
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005131 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5132 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5133 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5134 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5135 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5136 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5137 instead.
5138
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005139 Example:
5140 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5141 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005142
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005143http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005144
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005145 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005147http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5148 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005149
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005150 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5151 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5152 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5153 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5154 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5155 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5156 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5157 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5158 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005160 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5161 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5162 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005163 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5164
5165 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5166 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5167 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5168 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005170http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005172 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5173 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5174 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5175 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5176 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5177 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005179http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005181 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005182
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005183http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005184
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005185 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5186 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5187 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5188 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5189 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5190 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005191
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005192http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5193http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5194 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5195 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5196 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5197 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005198
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005199 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5200 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5201 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
5202 return" for details. For compatiblity purpose, when no argument is defined,
5203 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5204 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5205 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005206 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005207 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005208
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005209http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5210 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5211 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5212 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5213
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005214http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5215
5216 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5217 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5218 pointed by <resolvers>.
5219 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5220 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5221 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5222 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5223 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5224 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5225 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5226 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5227 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5228 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5229 to 0.0.0.0.
5230
5231 Example:
5232 resolvers mydns
5233 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5234 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5235 timeout retry 1s
5236 hold valid 10s
5237 hold nx 3s
5238 hold other 3s
5239 hold obsolete 0s
5240 accepted_payload_size 8192
5241
5242 frontend fe
5243 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5244 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5245 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5246
5247 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5248 # which mean DNS resolution error
5249 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5250
5251 default_backend be
5252
5253 backend b_503
5254 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5255 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5256 # 503 error page to end users
5257
5258 backend be
5259 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5260 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5261 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5262 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5263 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5264
5265 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5266 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5267
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005268http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5269
5270 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5271 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5272 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5273 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005274 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5275 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005276
5277 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5278
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005279http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005280
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005281 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5282 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5283 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5284 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5285 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005286
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005287http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005289 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5290 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5291 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5292 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005293
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005294http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5295 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005296
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005297 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005298 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5299 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5300 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5301 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5302 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005303
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005304 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5305 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5306 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5307 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5308 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005309
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005310 Example:
5311 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5312
5313 # applied to:
5314 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5315
5316 # outputs:
5317 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5318
5319 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005320
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005321 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5322
5323 # applied to:
5324 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005325
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005326 # outputs:
5327 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005328
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005329http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5330 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5331
5332 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5333 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5334 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5335 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5336
5337 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5338 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5339 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5340
5341 Example:
5342 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5343 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5344
5345 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5346 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5347
5348 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5349 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5350 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5351 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5352
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005353http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5354 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5355
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005356 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5357 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5358 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5359 against.
5360
5361 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5362 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5363 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005364
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005365 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5366 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5367 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5368 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5369 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5370 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5371 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5372 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5373 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005374 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5375 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005376
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005377 Example:
5378 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5379 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005380
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005381 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5382 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005384http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5385 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005386
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005387 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5388 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5389 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5390 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005391
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005392 Example:
5393 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005394
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005395 # applied to:
5396 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005397
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005398 # outputs:
5399 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005400
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005401http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5402 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5403 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005404 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005405 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5406
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005407 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005408 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5409 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5410 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5411 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005412 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005413 are followed to create the response :
5414
5415 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5416 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5417 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5418 ignored.
5419
5420 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5421 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
5422 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
5423 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5424 ignored.
5425
5426 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5427 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5428 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
5429 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
5430 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
5431
5432 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5433 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5434 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5435 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
5436 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
5437 if any, is ignored.
5438
5439 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5440 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5441 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5442 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5443 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5444 as a raw content.
5445
5446 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5447 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5448 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5449 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5450 considered as a raw string.
5451
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005452 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5453 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5454 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5455 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5456
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005457 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5458 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
5459 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
5460
5461 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5462
5463 Example:
5464 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5465 if { path /ping }
5466
5467 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5468 if { path /favicon.ico }
5469
5470 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5471 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5472 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5473
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005474http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5475http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005476
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005477 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5478 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5479 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005480
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005481http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5482 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005483
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005484 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5485 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5486 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5487 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005488
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005489http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005490
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005491 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5492 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5493 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5494 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5495 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005497 Arguments:
5498 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5499 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005500
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005501 Example:
5502 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5503 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005505 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5506 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005508http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005509
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005510 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5511 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5512 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005513
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005514 Arguments:
5515 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5516 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005518 Example:
5519 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5520 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005522 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5523 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5524 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005526http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005527
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005528 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5529 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5530 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5531 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5532 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005533
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005534 Example:
5535 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5536 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5537 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5538 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5539 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5540 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5541 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5542 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5543 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005544
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005545http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005547 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5548 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5549 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5550 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5551 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005552
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005553http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5554 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005556 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5557 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5558 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5559 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5560 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5561 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5562 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5563 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5564 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005565
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005566http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005568 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5569 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5570 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5571 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5572 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5573 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5574 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005575
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005576http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005578 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5579 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5580 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005582http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005584 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5585 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5586 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5587 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5588 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5589 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5590 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5591 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005592
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005593http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005594
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005595 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5596 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5597 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5598 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5599 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5600 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005602 Example :
5603 # prepend the host name before the path
5604 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005605
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005606http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005607
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005608 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5609 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5610 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5611 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5612 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005614http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005616 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5617 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5618 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5619 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5620 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5621 values have higher priority.
5622 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5623 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5624 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5625 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5626 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005628http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005629
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005630 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5631 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5632 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5633 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5634 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5635 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5636 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005638 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005639
5640 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005641 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5642 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005643
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005644http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5645 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5646 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5647 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005648 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5649 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005650
5651 Arguments :
5652 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5653 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005654
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005655 See also "option forwardfor".
5656
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005657 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005658 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5659 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5660
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005661 # After the masking this will track connections
5662 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5663 http-request track-sc0 src
5664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005665 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5666 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5667
5668http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5669
5670 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5671 expression.
5672
5673 Arguments:
5674 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5675 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005676
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005677 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005678 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5679 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5680
5681 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5682 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5683 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5684
5685http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5686
5687 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5688 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5689 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5690 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5691 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5692 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5693 information from the request.
5694
5695 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5696
5697http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5698
5699 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5700 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5701 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5702 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5703 path and the query string.
5704 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5705
5706http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5707
5708 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5709 inline.
5710
5711 Arguments:
5712 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5713 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5714 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5715 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5716 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5717 (request and response)
5718 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5719 processing
5720 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5721 processing
5722 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5723 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5724 and '_'.
5725
5726 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5727 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005728
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005729 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005730 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005732http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5733 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005734
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005735 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5736 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5737 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5738 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5739 agent name must be used.
5740
5741 Arguments:
5742 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5743
5744 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5745 configuration.
5746
5747http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5748
5749 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5750 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5751 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5752 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5753 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5754 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5755 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5756 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5757 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5758 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5759 action.
5760 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5761 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5762 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5763 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5764 you fully understand how it works.
5765
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005766http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5767
5768 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5769 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5770 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5771 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5772 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005773 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005774 processing.
5775
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005776 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005777 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5778 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5779 rules evaluation.
5780
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005781http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5782http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5783 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5784 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5785 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5786 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005787
5788 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5789 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5790 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005791 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
5792 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
5793 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
5794 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
5795 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
5796 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
5797 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
5798 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
5799 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
5800 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
5801 For compatiblity purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
5802 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5803 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5804 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
5805 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5806 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005807
5808http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5809http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5810http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5811
5812 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5813 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5814 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5815 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5816 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5817 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5818 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5819 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5820 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5821 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5822 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5823 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5824
5825 Arguments :
5826 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5827 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5828 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5829 select which table entry to update the counters.
5830
5831 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5832 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5833 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5834 that table until the session ends.
5835
5836 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5837 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5838 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5839 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5840 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5841 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5842 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5843 useful information.
5844
5845 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5846 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5847 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5848 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5849 checks that make use of it.
5850
5851http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5852
5853 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005854
5855 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005856 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005857
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005858http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5859
5860 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5861 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5862 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5863 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5864 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5865 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5866
5867 Arguments :
5868 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5869
5870 Example:
5871 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5872
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005873http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005874
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005875 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5876 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5877 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005878
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005879
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005880http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005881 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5882
5883 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5884 no | yes | yes | yes
5885
5886 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5887 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5888 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5889 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5890 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5891 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5892
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005893 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5894 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005895
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005896 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005897
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005898 Example:
5899 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005900
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005901 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005903 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5904 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005905
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005906 Example:
5907 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005908
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005909 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005910
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005911 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5912 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005913
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005914 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5915 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005916
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005917http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005918
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005919 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5920 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5921 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5922 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5923 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5924 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5925 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5926 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005927
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005928http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005930 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5931 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5932 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5933 example, or to pass some internal information.
5934 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5935 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5936 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005937
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005938http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005940 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5941 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005942
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005943http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005944
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005945 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005947http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005948
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005949 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5950 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5951 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5952 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5953 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5954 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5955 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005956
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005957 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5958 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5959 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5960 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5961 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005962
5963 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5964 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5965 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5966 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005968http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005970 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5971 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5972 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5973 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5974 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5975 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005976
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005977http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005979 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005981http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005982
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005983 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5984 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5985 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5986 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5987 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5988 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005989
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005990http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5991http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5992 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5993 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5994 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5995 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005996
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005997 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
5998 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5999 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
6000 "http-response return" for details. For compatiblity purpose, when no
6001 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6002 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6003 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006004 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006005 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006006
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006007http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006008
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006009 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6010 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6011 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6012 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6013 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6014 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006015
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006016http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6017 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006018
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006019 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6020 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006022 Example:
6023 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006024
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006025 # applied to:
6026 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006028 # outputs:
6029 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006031 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006033http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6034 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006035
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006036 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006037 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006038
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006039 Example:
6040 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006041
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006042 # applied to:
6043 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006045 # outputs:
6046 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006047
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006048http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6049 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6050 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006051 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006052 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6053
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006054 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006055 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6056 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
6057 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
6058 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006059 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006060 are followed to create the response :
6061
6062 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6063 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6064 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6065 ignored.
6066
6067 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6068 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
6069 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425,
6070 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6071 ignored.
6072
6073 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6074 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6075 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
6076 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
6077 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
6078
6079 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6080 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6081 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
6082 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
6083 408, 410, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument,
6084 if any, is ignored.
6085
6086 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6087 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6088 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6089 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6090 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6091 as a raw content.
6092
6093 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6094 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6095 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6096 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6097 considered as a raw string.
6098
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006099 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6100 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6101 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6102 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6103
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006104 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6105 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
6106 reserved to the headers rewritting should also be free.
6107
6108 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6109
6110 Example:
6111 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
6112 if { status eq 404 }
6113
6114 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6115 string "This is the end !" \
6116 if { status eq 500 }
6117
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006118http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6119http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006120
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006121 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6122 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6123 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006124
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006125http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6126 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006127
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006128 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6129 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6130 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6131 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006132
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006133http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006134
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006135 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6136 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6137 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6138 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6139 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006140
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006141 Arguments:
6142 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006143
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006144 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6145 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006146
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006147http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006148
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006149 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6150 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6151 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006152
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006153http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6154
6155 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6156 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6157 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6158 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6159 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6160
6161http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6162
6163 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6164 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6165 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6166 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6167 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6168 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6169 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6170 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6171 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6172
6173http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6174
6175 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6176 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6177 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6178 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6179 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6180 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6181 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6182
6183http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6184
6185 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6186 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6187 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6188 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6189 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6190 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6191 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6192 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6193
6194http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6195 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6196
6197 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6198 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6199 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6200 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006201
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006202 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006203 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6204 http-response set-status 431
6205 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6206 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006207
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006208http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006209
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006210 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6211 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6212 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6213 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6214 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6215 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6216 based on some information from the request.
6217
6218 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6219
6220http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6221
6222 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6223 inline.
6224
6225 Arguments:
6226 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6227 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6228 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6229 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6230 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6231 (request and response)
6232 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6233 processing
6234 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6235 processing
6236 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6237 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6238 and '_'.
6239
6240 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6241 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006242
6243 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006244 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006245
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006246http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006247
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006248 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6249 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6250 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6251 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6252 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6253 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6254 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6255 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6256 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6257 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6258 action.
6259 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6260 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6261 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6262 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6263 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006264
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006265http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6266
6267 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6268 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6269 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6270 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6271 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006272 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006273 processing.
6274
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006275 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006276 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6277 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
6278 rules evaluation.
6279
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006280http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6281http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6282http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006283
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006284 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6285 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6286 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6287 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6288 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6289 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6290
6291http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6292
6293 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6294 about <var-name>.
6295
6296 Example:
6297 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6298
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006299
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006300http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6301 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6302
6303 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6304 yes | no | yes | yes
6305
6306 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006307 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6308 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6309 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006310
6311 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6312
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006313 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6314 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6315 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6316 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6317 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6318 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6319 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6320 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6321 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6322 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006323
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006324 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6325 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6326 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6327 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6328 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6329 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6330 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6331 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006332
6333 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6334 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6335 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6336 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6337 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6338 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6339 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6340 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006341 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006342 downsides of rare connection failures.
6343
6344 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6345 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6346 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6347 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6348 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6349 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006350 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006351 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6352 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6353 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6354 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6355 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6356
6357 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006358 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6359 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6360 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006361
6362 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006363 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006364
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006365 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6366 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006367
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006368 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006369
6370 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6371 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6372 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6373
6374 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6375
6376
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006377http-send-name-header [<header>]
6378 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006379 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6380 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006381 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006382 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6383
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006384 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6385 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6386 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6387 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6388 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6389 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6390 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6391 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6392 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6393 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6394 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6395 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6396 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6397 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6398 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6399 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006400
6401 See also : "server"
6402
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006403id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006404 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6406 no | yes | yes | yes
6407 Arguments : none
6408
6409 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6410 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6411 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006412
6413
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006414ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6415 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6416 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006417 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006418
6419 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6420 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6421 and running).
6422
6423 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6424 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6425 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006426 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006427 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6428
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006429 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6430 "unless" condition is met.
6431
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006432 Example:
6433 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6434 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6435 ignore-persist if url_static
6436
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006437 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6438
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006439load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6440 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6441 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6442 yes | no | yes | yes
6443
6444 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6445 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6446 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006447 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006448 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6449 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6450 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6451 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6452
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006453 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006454 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006455 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006456
6457 Arguments:
6458 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6459 named "server-state-file".
6460
6461 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6462 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6463 name is used as a file name.
6464
6465 none don't load any stat for this backend
6466
6467 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006468 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6469 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6470 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006471 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006472 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006473
6474 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6475 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6476
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006477 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006478
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006479 global
6480 stats socket /tmp/socket
6481 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006482
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006483 defaults
6484 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006485
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006486 backend bk
6487 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6488 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006489
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006490
6491 Then one can run :
6492
6493 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6494
6495 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6496
6497 1
6498 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6499 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6500 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6501
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006502 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006503
6504 global
6505 stats socket /tmp/socket
6506 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6507
6508 defaults
6509 load-server-state-from-file local
6510
6511 backend bk
6512 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6513 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6514
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006515
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006516 Then one can run :
6517
6518 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6519
6520 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6521
6522 1
6523 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6524 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6525 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6526
6527 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6528 "show servers state"
6529
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006530
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006531log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006532log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6533 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006534no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006535 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6537 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006538
6539 Prefix :
6540 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6541 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6542 prefix does not allow arguments.
6543
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006544 Arguments :
6545 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6546 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6547 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6548 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6549 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6550 parameter.
6551
6552 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6553 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6554
6555 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6556 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6557 standard syslog port).
6558
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006559 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6560 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6561 standard syslog port).
6562
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006563 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6564 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6565 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006566 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006567
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006568 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6569 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6570 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6571 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6572 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6573 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6574 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6575 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6576 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6577 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6578 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6579 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6580 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6581 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6582 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6583 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006584 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6585 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006586
6587 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6588 and "fd@2", see above.
6589
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006590 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6591 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6592 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6593 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6594 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6595 having the logs instantly available.
6596
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006597 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6598 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006599
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006600 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6601 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6602 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6603 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6604 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6605 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6606 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6607 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6608 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6609 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006610 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006611
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006612 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6613 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6614 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6615 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6616 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6617
6618 <sample_size>
6619 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6620 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6621 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6622 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6623 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6624
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006625 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6626 one of the following :
6627
6628 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6629 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6630
6631 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6632 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6633
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006634 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6635 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6636 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6637 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6638 systemd logger consumes.
6639
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006640 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6641 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6642 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6643 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6644
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006645 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6646
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006647 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6648 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6649 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6650
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006651 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6652 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6653 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6654 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006655
6656 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6657 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6658 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006659 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6660 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6661 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6662 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6663 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006664
6665 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6666
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006667 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6668 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6669 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006670
6671 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6672 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6673 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6674 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6675
6676 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6677 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006678
6679 Example :
6680 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006681 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6682 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6683 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006684 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6685 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006686 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006687
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006688
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006689log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006690 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6691 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6692 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006693
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006694 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6695 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6696 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6697 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6698 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006699
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006700 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6701 "option httplog" directives.
6702
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006703log-format-sd <string>
6704 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6705 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6706 yes | yes | yes | no
6707
6708 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6709 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6710 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6711 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6712 which covers the log format string in depth.
6713
6714 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6715 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6716
6717 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6718 log format to "rfc5424".
6719
6720 Example :
6721 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6722
6723
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006724log-tag <string>
6725 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6726 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6727 yes | yes | yes | yes
6728
6729 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6730 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6731 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6732 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6733 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6734 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6735 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6736 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6737 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006738
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006739max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6740 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6741 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6742 yes | no | yes | yes
6743
6744 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6745 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6746 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6747 servers.
6748
6749 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6750 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6751 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6752 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6753 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006754 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006755 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6756 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6757 picking a different server.
6758
6759 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6760 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6761 even if they have to be queued.
6762
6763 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6764 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6765
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006766max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6767 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6768 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6769 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006770
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006771maxconn <conns>
6772 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6774 yes | yes | yes | no
6775 Arguments :
6776 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6777 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6778 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6779 closes.
6780
6781 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6782 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6783 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6784 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006785 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6786 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6787 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6788 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006789
6790 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6791 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6792 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6793
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006794 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6795 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006796
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006797 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6798
6799
6800mode { tcp|http|health }
6801 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6803 yes | yes | yes | yes
6804 Arguments :
6805 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6806 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6807 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6808 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6809
6810 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6811 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6812 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6813 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6814 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6815
6816 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006817 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6818 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6819 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6820 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6821 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6822 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6823 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006824
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006825 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6826 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6827 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006828
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006829 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006830 defaults http_instances
6831 mode http
6832
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006833 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006834
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006835
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006836monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006837 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6839 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006840 Arguments :
6841 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6842 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006843 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006844 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6845 backend and its backup.
6846
6847 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6848 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6849 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6850 servers in a list of backends.
6851
6852 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6853 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6854 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6855 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6856 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6857 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6858 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006859 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6860 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006861
6862 Example:
6863 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006864 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006865 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6866 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6867 monitor-uri /site_alive
6868 monitor fail if site_dead
6869
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006870 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006871
6872
6873monitor-net <source>
6874 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6876 yes | yes | yes | no
6877 Arguments :
6878 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6879 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6880 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6881 followed by a mask.
6882
6883 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6884 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006885 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006886 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6887
6888 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6889 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6890 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6891 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006892 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6893 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6894 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006895
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006896 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6897 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6898 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6899 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6900 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6901 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006902
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006903 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6904 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006905
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006906 Example :
6907 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6908 frontend www
6909 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6910
6911 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6912
6913
6914monitor-uri <uri>
6915 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6917 yes | yes | yes | no
6918 Arguments :
6919 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6920 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6921
6922 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6923 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6924 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6925 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6926 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6927 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6928 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6929 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6930
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006931 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006932 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6933 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6934 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6935 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6936 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6937 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006938
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006939 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6940 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6941 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6942 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6943
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006944 Example :
6945 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6946 frontend www
6947 mode http
6948 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6949
6950 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006952
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006953option abortonclose
6954no option abortonclose
6955 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6957 yes | no | yes | yes
6958 Arguments : none
6959
6960 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6961 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6962 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6963 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006964 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006965 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
6966 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
6967 encountered while delivering the response.
6968
6969 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
6970 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
6971 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
6972 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
6973 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
6974 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006975 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006976 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006977 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006978 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
6979 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
6980 still not served and not pollute the servers.
6981
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006982 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
6983 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006984 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
6985 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
6986 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
6987 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
6988 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
6989 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006990 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006991
6992 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6993 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6994
6995 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
6996
6997
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02006998option accept-invalid-http-request
6999no option accept-invalid-http-request
7000 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7002 yes | yes | yes | no
7003 Arguments : none
7004
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007005 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007006 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007007 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007008 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7009 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7010 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7011 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7012 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007013 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7014 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7015 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7016 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007017 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007018 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007019 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7020 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7021 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007022
7023 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7024 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7025 been confirmed.
7026
7027 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7028 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007029 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7030 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007031 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7032
7033 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7034 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7035
7036 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7037 stats socket.
7038
7039
7040option accept-invalid-http-response
7041no option accept-invalid-http-response
7042 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7044 yes | no | yes | yes
7045 Arguments : none
7046
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007047 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007048 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007049 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007050 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7051 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7052 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7053 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7054 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007055 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7056 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7057 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007058
7059 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7060 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7061 been confirmed.
7062
7063 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7064 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7065 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7066 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7067
7068 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7069 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7070
7071 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7072 stats socket.
7073
7074
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007075option allbackups
7076no option allbackups
7077 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7079 yes | no | yes | yes
7080 Arguments : none
7081
7082 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7083 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7084 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7085 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7086 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7087 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7088 order between the backup servers anymore.
7089
7090 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7091 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7092
7093 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7094 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7095
7096
7097option checkcache
7098no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007099 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7101 yes | no | yes | yes
7102 Arguments : none
7103
7104 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7105 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007106 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007107 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7108 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007109 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007110
7111 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007112 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007113 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007114 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7115 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007116 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007117 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007118 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7119 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007120 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007121 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7122 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007123 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007124 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7125 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7126 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7127 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7128 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7129 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7130 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7131 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7132 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7133
7134 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007135 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7136 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7137 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7138 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007139
7140 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7141 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007142 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007143 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007144
7145 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7146 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7147
7148
7149option clitcpka
7150no option clitcpka
7151 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7153 yes | yes | yes | no
7154 Arguments : none
7155
7156 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7157 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007158 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007159 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7160
7161 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7162 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7163 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7164 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7165
7166 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7167 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7168 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7169 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7170 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7171
7172 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7173
7174 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7175 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7176 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7177
7178 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7179 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7180
7181 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7182
7183
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007184option contstats
7185 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7187 yes | yes | yes | no
7188 Arguments : none
7189
7190 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7191 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7192 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7193 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007194 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7195 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7196 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7197 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7198 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007199
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007200option disable-h2-upgrade
7201no option disable-h2-upgrade
7202 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7203 connection.
7204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7205 yes | yes | yes | no
7206 Arguments : none
7207
7208 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7209 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7210 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7211 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7212 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7213 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7214 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7215 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7216
7217 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7218 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007219
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007220option dontlog-normal
7221no option dontlog-normal
7222 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7224 yes | yes | yes | no
7225 Arguments : none
7226
7227 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7228 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7229 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7230 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7231 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7232 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7233 logged.
7234
7235 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7236 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7237 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007239 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007240 logging.
7241
7242
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007243option dontlognull
7244no option dontlognull
7245 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7247 yes | yes | yes | no
7248 Arguments : none
7249
7250 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7251 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7252 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7253 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7254 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7255 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007256 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7257 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7258 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007259
7260 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007261 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007262 would not be logged.
7263
7264 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7265 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7266
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007267 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7268 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007269
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007270
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007271option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007272 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7274 yes | yes | yes | yes
7275 Arguments :
7276 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7277 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007278 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007279 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007280
7281 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7282 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7283 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7284 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7285 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7286 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7287 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007288 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7289 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7290 possible that the client has already brought one.
7291
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007292 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007293 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007294 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007295 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007296 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007297 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007298
7299 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7300 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7301 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7302 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7303 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7304 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7305 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7306
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007307 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7308 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7309 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7310 are under the control of the end-user.
7311
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007312 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007313 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7314 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007315 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7316 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7317 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007318
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007319 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007320 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7321 frontend www
7322 mode http
7323 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7324
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007325 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7326 backend www
7327 mode http
7328 option forwardfor header X-Client
7329
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007330 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007331 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007332
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007333
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007334option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7335no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7336 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7338 yes | yes | yes | no
7339 Arguments : none
7340
7341 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7342 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7343 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7344 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7345 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7346 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7347 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7348
7349 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7350 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7351 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7352 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7353 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7354 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7355 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7356 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7357 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7358 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7359
7360 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7361
7362 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7363 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7364
7365 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7366 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7367
7368
7369option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7370no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7371 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7373 yes | no | yes | yes
7374 Arguments : none
7375
7376 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7377 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7378 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7379 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7380 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7381 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7382 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7383
7384 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7385 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7386 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7387 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7388 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7389 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7390 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7391 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7392 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7393 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7394
7395 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7396
7397 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7398 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7399
7400 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7401 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7402
7403
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007404option http-buffer-request
7405no option http-buffer-request
7406 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7408 yes | yes | yes | yes
7409 Arguments : none
7410
7411 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7412 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7413 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7414 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7415 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7416 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007417 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7418 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7419 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7420 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007421
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007422 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007423
7424
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007425option http-ignore-probes
7426no option http-ignore-probes
7427 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7429 yes | yes | yes | no
7430 Arguments : none
7431
7432 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7433 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7434 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7435 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7436 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7437 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7438 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7439 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7440 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007441 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7442 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007443 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7444
7445 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7446 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7447 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7448 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7449 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7450 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7451 are often the only way to detect them.
7452
7453 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7454 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7455
7456 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7457
7458
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007459option http-keep-alive
7460no option http-keep-alive
7461 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7463 yes | yes | yes | yes
7464 Arguments : none
7465
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007466 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7467 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007468 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7469 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007470 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7471 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7472 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007473
7474 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7475 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007476 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7477 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7478 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7479 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7480 situations where this option may be useful :
7481
7482 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007483 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007484
7485 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7486 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7487
7488 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7489 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7490 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7491 request.
7492
7493 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7494 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007495 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7496 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7497 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007498
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007499 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7500 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7501 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7502 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7503 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7504 not set.
7505
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007506 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7507 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7508 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007509
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007510 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007511 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007512 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007513
7514
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007515option http-no-delay
7516no option http-no-delay
7517 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7518 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7519 yes | yes | yes | yes
7520 Arguments : none
7521
7522 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7523 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7524 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7525 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7526 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7527 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7528 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7529 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7530 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7531 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7532 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7533 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7534 affected.
7535
7536 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7537 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7538 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7539 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7540 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7541 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7542 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7543 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7544 latency environments.
7545
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007546 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7547
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007548
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007549option http-pretend-keepalive
7550no option http-pretend-keepalive
7551 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007553 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007554 Arguments : none
7555
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007556 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007557 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7558 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7559 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7560 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7561 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7562 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7563 consider the response complete.
7564
7565 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7566 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7567 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7568 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007569 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007570 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7571
7572 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7573 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7574 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7575 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7576 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7577 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7578 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7579
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007580 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7581 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7582 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7583 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7584 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7585 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007586
7587 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7588 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7589
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007590 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007591 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007592
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007593
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007594option http-server-close
7595no option http-server-close
7596 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7598 yes | yes | yes | yes
7599 Arguments : none
7600
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007601 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7602 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7603 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7604 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007605 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7606 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7607 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7608 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7609 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7610 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7611 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7612 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7613 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7614 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7615 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007616
7617 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7618 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7619 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7620 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007621 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7622 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007623
7624 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7625 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007626 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7627 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7628 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007629
7630 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7631 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7632
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007633 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7634 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007635
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007636option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007637no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007638 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7640 yes | yes | yes | no
7641 Arguments : none
7642
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007643 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007644 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7645 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7646 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7647 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7648 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7649 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7650
7651 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7652 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007653 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7654 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7655 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007656
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007657 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7658 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7659 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7660 front of an existing proxy.
7661
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007662 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7663
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007664 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007665
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007666option httpchk
7667option httpchk <uri>
7668option httpchk <method> <uri>
7669option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007670 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007671 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7672 yes | no | yes | yes
7673 Arguments :
7674 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7675 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7676 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7677 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7678 ones.
7679
7680 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7681 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7682 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7683
7684 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7685 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7686 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007687 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007688
7689 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7690 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7691 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7692 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7693 the lack of any response.
7694
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007695 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7696 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7697 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7698 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7699
7700 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7701 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7702 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007703
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007704 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7705 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007706 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7707 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7708 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007709
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007710 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7711 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7712 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7713 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7714
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007715 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007716 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7717 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7718 backend https_relay
7719 mode tcp
7720 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7721 http-check send hdr Host www
7722 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007723
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007724 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7725 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7726 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007727
7728
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007729option httpclose
7730no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007731 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7733 yes | yes | yes | yes
7734 Arguments : none
7735
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007736 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7737 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7738 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7739 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007740 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007741
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007742 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7743 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007744 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007745 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7746 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007747
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007748 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7749 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7750 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007751
7752 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7753 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007754 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7755 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7756 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007757
7758 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7759 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7760
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007761 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007762
7763
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007764option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007765 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007767 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007768 Arguments :
7769 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7770 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7771 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007772 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007773 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007774
7775 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7776 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7777 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7778 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7779 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7780 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7781 ports.
7782
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007783 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7784 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007785
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007786 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7787
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007788 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007789
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007790
7791option http_proxy
7792no option http_proxy
7793 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7795 yes | yes | yes | yes
7796 Arguments : none
7797
7798 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7799 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7800 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7801 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7802 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7803
7804 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7805 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007806 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7807 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007808
7809 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7810 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7811
7812 Example :
7813 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7814 backend direct_forward
7815 option httpclose
7816 option http_proxy
7817
7818 See also : "option httpclose"
7819
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007820
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007821option independent-streams
7822no option independent-streams
7823 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7825 yes | yes | yes | yes
7826 Arguments : none
7827
7828 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7829 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7830 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7831 receive data or not.
7832
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007833 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007834 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7835 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7836 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7837 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7838 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7839 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7840 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7841 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7842 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7843 socket buffers.
7844
7845 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7846 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7847 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7848 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7849 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7850
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007851 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007852
7853
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007854option ldap-check
7855 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7857 yes | no | yes | yes
7858 Arguments : none
7859
7860 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7861 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7862 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7863 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7864
7865 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7866 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7867
7868 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7869 configure it.
7870
7871 Example :
7872 option ldap-check
7873
7874 See also : "option httpchk"
7875
7876
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007877option external-check
7878 Use external processes for server health checks
7879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7880 yes | no | yes | yes
7881
7882 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7883 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7884 command".
7885
7886 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7887
7888 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7889
7890
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007891option log-health-checks
7892no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007893 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7895 yes | no | yes | yes
7896 Arguments : none
7897
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007898 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7899 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7900 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007901
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007902 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7903 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7904 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7905 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7906 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7907
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007908 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007909 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007910
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007911 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7912 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7913 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007914
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007915
7916option log-separate-errors
7917no option log-separate-errors
7918 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7920 yes | yes | yes | no
7921 Arguments : none
7922
7923 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7924 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7925 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7926 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7927 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7928 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7929 provides very important information.
7930
7931 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7932 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7933 error logs.
7934
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007935 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007936 logging.
7937
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007938
7939option logasap
7940no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007941 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7943 yes | yes | yes | no
7944 Arguments : none
7945
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007946 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7947 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7948 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7949 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7950
7951 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7952 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7953 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7954 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7955 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007956 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007957 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7958 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7959 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7960 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007961 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007962
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007963 Examples :
7964 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7965 mode http
7966 option httplog
7967 option logasap
7968 log 192.168.2.200 local3
7969
7970 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7971 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7972 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
7973 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
7974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007975 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007976 logging.
7977
7978
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02007979option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007980 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01007981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7982 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007983 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007984 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
7985 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02007986 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
7987 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007988
7989 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
7990 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007991 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02007992 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
7993 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
7994 in the MySQL table, like this :
7995
7996 USE mysql;
7997 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
7998 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
7999
8000 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008001 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008002 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8003 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8004 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8005 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8006 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8007 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8008 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8009
8010 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8011 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008012
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008013 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008014
8015 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8016 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8017 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8018 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008019 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8020 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008021
8022 See also: "option httpchk"
8023
8024
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008025option nolinger
8026no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008027 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008028 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8029 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008030 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008031
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008032 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008033 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8034 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8035 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8036 connections.
8037
8038 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8039 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8040 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8041 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8042 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8043 this too.
8044
8045 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8046 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8047 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8048
8049 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8050 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8051 for servers.
8052
8053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8055
8056
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008057option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8058 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8060 yes | yes | yes | yes
8061 Arguments :
8062 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8063 matching <network>
8064 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8065 header name.
8066
8067 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8068 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8069 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8070 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8071 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8072 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8073 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8074 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8075 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8076 possible that the client has already brought one.
8077
8078 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8079 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8080 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8081 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8082 header and requires different one.
8083
8084 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8085 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8086 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8087 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8088 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8089 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8090 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8091
8092 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8093 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8094 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8095 both are defined.
8096
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008097 Examples :
8098 # Original Destination address
8099 frontend www
8100 mode http
8101 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8102
8103 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8104 backend www
8105 mode http
8106 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8107
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008108 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008109
8110
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008111option persist
8112no option persist
8113 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8114 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8115 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008116 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008117
8118 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8119 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8120 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8121 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8122 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8123 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8124 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8125 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8126 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8127 redirected to another valid server.
8128
8129 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8130 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8131
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008132 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008133
8134
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008135option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8136 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8138 yes | no | yes | yes
8139 Arguments :
8140 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8141 PostgreSQL server.
8142
8143 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8144 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8145 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8146 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8147
8148 See also: "option httpchk"
8149
8150
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008151option prefer-last-server
8152no option prefer-last-server
8153 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8154 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8155 yes | no | yes | yes
8156 Arguments : none
8157
8158 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8159 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8160 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8161 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8162 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8163 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8164 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8165 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8166 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008167 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8168 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008169 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8170 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8171 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008172 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8173 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8174 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008175
8176 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8177 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8178
8179 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8180
8181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008182option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008183option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008184no option redispatch
8185 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8186 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8187 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008188 Arguments :
8189 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8190 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8191 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008192 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008193 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008194 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008195 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8196 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8197 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8198
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008199
8200 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8201 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8202 be able to access the service anymore.
8203
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008204 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8205 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008206
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008207 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8208 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8209 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8210 following order:
8211
8212 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8213
8214 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8215 list, or
8216
8217 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8218
8219 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8220 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8221
8222 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8223 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8224 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8225 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8226
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008227 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008228 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8229 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8233
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008234 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008235
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008236
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008237option redis-check
8238 Use redis health checks for server testing
8239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8240 yes | no | yes | yes
8241 Arguments : none
8242
8243 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8244 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8245 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8246 find the "+PONG" response message.
8247
8248 Example :
8249 option redis-check
8250
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008251 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008252
8253
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008254option smtpchk
8255option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8256 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8258 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008259 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008260 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008261 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008262 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8263
8264 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8265 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8266 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8267
8268 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8269 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8270 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8271 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8272 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8273 dead server.
8274
8275 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8276 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008277 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008278 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8279
8280 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8281 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8282 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8283 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008284 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008285
8286 Example :
8287 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8288
8289 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8290
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008292option socket-stats
8293no option socket-stats
8294
8295 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8297 yes | yes | yes | no
8298
8299 Arguments : none
8300
8301
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008302option splice-auto
8303no option splice-auto
8304 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8306 yes | yes | yes | yes
8307 Arguments : none
8308
8309 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8310 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008311 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008312 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008313 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008314 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8315 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8316 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8317 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8318
8319 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8320 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8321 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8322 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8323 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8324 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8325 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8326 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8327 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8328 keyword.
8329
8330 Example :
8331 option splice-auto
8332
8333 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8334 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8335
8336 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8337 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8338
8339
8340option splice-request
8341no option splice-request
8342 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8344 yes | yes | yes | yes
8345 Arguments : none
8346
8347 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008348 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008349 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8350 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8351 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8352 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8353
8354 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8355
8356 Example :
8357 option splice-request
8358
8359 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8360 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8361
8362 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8363 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8364
8365
8366option splice-response
8367no option splice-response
8368 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8369 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8370 yes | yes | yes | yes
8371 Arguments : none
8372
8373 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008374 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008375 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8376 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8377 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8378 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8379
8380 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8381
8382 Example :
8383 option splice-response
8384
8385 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8386 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8387
8388 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8389 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8390
8391
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008392option spop-check
8393 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8395 no | no | no | yes
8396 Arguments : none
8397
8398 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8399 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8400 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8401 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8402
8403 Example :
8404 option spop-check
8405
8406 See also : "option httpchk"
8407
8408
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008409option srvtcpka
8410no option srvtcpka
8411 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8412 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8413 yes | no | yes | yes
8414 Arguments : none
8415
8416 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8417 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008418 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008419 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8420
8421 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8422 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8423 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8424 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8425
8426 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8427 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8428 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8429 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8430 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8431
8432 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8433
8434 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8435 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8436 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8437
8438 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8439 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8440
8441 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8442
8443
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008444option ssl-hello-chk
8445 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8447 yes | no | yes | yes
8448 Arguments : none
8449
8450 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8451 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8452 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8453 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8454 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8455 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8456 hello message.
8457
8458 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8459 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8460 messages, which is appreciable.
8461
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008462 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8463 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8464 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008465
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008466 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8467
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008468
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008469option tcp-check
8470 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8472 yes | no | yes | yes
8473
8474 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8475 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8476
8477 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8478 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8479 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8480
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008481 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008482 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8483 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8484 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8485 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8486 only.
8487
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008488 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008489 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8490 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8491 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8492 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8493
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008494 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008495 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8496 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008497 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008498 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8499 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8500 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8501 the respective protocols.
8502 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008503 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008504
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008505 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008506
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008507 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8508 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8509 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8510 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008511
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008512 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8513 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8514 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008515
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008516
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008517 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008518 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008519 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008520 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008521
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008522 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008523 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008524 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008525
8526 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8527 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008528 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008529 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008530 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008531 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008532 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008533 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008534 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8535 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008536 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008537 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8538 tcp-check expect string +OK
8539
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008540 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008541 (send many headers before analyzing)
8542 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008543 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008544 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8545 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8546 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8547 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008548 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008549
8550
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008551 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008552
8553
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008554option tcp-smart-accept
8555no option tcp-smart-accept
8556 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8558 yes | yes | yes | no
8559 Arguments : none
8560
8561 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8562 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8563 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8564 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8565 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8566 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8567
8568 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8569 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8570 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8571 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8572
8573 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8574 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8575 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008576 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008577
8578 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8579 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8580 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8581
8582 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8583 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8584 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8585
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008586 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8587
8588
8589option tcp-smart-connect
8590no option tcp-smart-connect
8591 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8593 yes | no | yes | yes
8594 Arguments : none
8595
8596 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8597 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8598 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8599 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8600 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8601
8602 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8603 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8604 complex.
8605
8606 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8607 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8608 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8609
8610 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8611 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8612
8613 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8614
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008615
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008616option tcpka
8617 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8619 yes | yes | yes | yes
8620 Arguments : none
8621
8622 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8623 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008624 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008625 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8626
8627 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8628 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8629 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8630 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8631
8632 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8633 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8634 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8635 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8636 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8637
8638 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8639
8640 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8641 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8642 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8643 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8644 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8645 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8646 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8647 backends.
8648
8649 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8650
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008651
8652option tcplog
8653 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008655 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008656 Arguments : none
8657
8658 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8659 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8660 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8661 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8662 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8663 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8664 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8665 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8666
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008667 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8668
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008669 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008670
8671
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008672option transparent
8673no option transparent
8674 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008676 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008677 Arguments : none
8678
8679 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8680 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8681 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8682 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8683 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8684 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8685 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8686 appropriate server.
8687
8688 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8689 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8690
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008691 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008692 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008693
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008694
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008695external-check command <command>
8696 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8698 yes | no | yes | yes
8699
8700 Arguments :
8701 <command> is the external command to run
8702
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008703 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8704
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008705 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008706
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008707 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8708 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8709 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8710 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8711 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8712 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008713
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008714 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8715
8716 Environment variables :
8717 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8718 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8719
8720 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8721
8722 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8723
8724 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8725 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8726 for a UNIX socket).
8727
8728 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8729
8730 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8731
8732 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8733
8734 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8735
8736 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8737
8738 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8739 socket).
8740
8741 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8742 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8743
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008744 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8745
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008746 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8747 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8748 failed.
8749
8750 Example :
8751 external-check command /bin/true
8752
8753 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8754
8755
8756external-check path <path>
8757 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8759 yes | no | yes | yes
8760
8761 Arguments :
8762 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8763
8764 The default path is "".
8765
8766 Example :
8767 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8768
8769 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8770 "external-check command"
8771
8772
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008773persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008774persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008775 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8777 yes | no | yes | yes
8778 Arguments :
8779 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008780 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8781 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008782
8783 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8784 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008785 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008786 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8787 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8788 forwarded to this server.
8789
8790 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8791 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8792 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008793 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008794 a single "listen" section.
8795
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008796 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8797 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8798 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8799
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008800 Example :
8801 listen tse-farm
8802 bind :3389
8803 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8804 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8805 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8806 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8807 persist rdp-cookie
8808 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008809 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008810 balance rdp-cookie
8811 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8812 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8813
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008814 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8815 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008816
8817
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008818rate-limit sessions <rate>
8819 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8821 yes | yes | yes | no
8822 Arguments :
8823 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8824 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8825
8826 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8827 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8828 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8829 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8830 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8831 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8832
8833 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8834 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8835 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8836 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8837
8838 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8839 listen smtp
8840 mode tcp
8841 bind :25
8842 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008843 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008844
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008845 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8846 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8847 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008848
8849 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8850
8851
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008852redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8853redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8854redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008855 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8857 no | yes | yes | yes
8858
8859 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008860 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008861
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008862 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008863 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008864 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8865 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8866 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008867
8868 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8869 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8870 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8871 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8872 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008873 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8874 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8875 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8876 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008877
8878 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8879 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8880 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8881 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8882 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8883 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008884 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008885 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008886 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8887 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8888 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008889
8890 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008891 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8892 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8893 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008894 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008895 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8896 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8897 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8898 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008899
8900 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008901 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008902
8903 - "drop-query"
8904 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8905 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8906 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8907 with a location-type redirect.
8908
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008909 - "append-slash"
8910 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8911 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8912 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8913 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8914
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008915 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8916 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8917 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8918 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8919 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8920 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8921 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8922
8923 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8924 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8925 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8926 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8927 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8928 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8929 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008930
8931 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8932 acl clear dst_port 80
8933 acl secure dst_port 8080
8934 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008935 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008936 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008937 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8938
8939 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008940 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8941 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8942 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008943 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008944
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008945 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8946 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8947 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8948
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008949 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008950 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008951
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008952 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008953 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8954 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8955 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008956
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008957 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008958
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008959
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008960retries <value>
8961 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8963 yes | no | yes | yes
8964 Arguments :
8965 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
8966 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
8967 default value is 3.
8968
8969 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
8970 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
8971 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
8972
8973 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008974 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
8975 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008976
8977 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
8978 server even if a cookie references a different server.
8979
8980 See also : "option redispatch"
8981
8982
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008983retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02008984 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
8985 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
8986 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02008987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8988 yes | no | yes | yes
8989 Arguments :
8990 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
8991 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
8992 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
8993 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
8994
8995 none never retry
8996
8997 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
8998 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
8999
9000 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9001 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9002 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9003 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9004 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9005 processing the request.
9006
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009007 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9008 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9009 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9010 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9011 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9012 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9013 overflow attack for example).
9014
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009015 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9016 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9017 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9018 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9019 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9020 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9021 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9022 amplify denial of service attacks.
9023
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009024 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9025 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9026 considered to be safe to retry.
9027
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009028 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9029 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9030 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9031 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9032
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009033 all-retryable-errors
9034 retry request for any error that are considered
9035 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9036 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9037 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9038
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009039 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9040 not cumulative.
9041
9042 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9043 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9044 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9045 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9046
9047 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9048 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9049 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9050 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9051 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9052 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9053 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9054 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9055 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9056 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9057 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9058 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9059
9060 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9061 should not use this directive.
9062
9063 The default is "conn-failure".
9064
9065 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9066
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009067server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009068 Declare a server in a backend
9069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9070 no | no | yes | yes
9071 Arguments :
9072 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009073 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009074 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009075
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009076 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9077 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9078 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9079 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009080 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9081 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9082 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9083 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9084 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009085 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9086 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9087 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9088 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9089 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9090 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9091 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009092 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009093 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9094 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9095 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9096 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9097 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9098 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009099 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9100 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009101 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9102 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009103
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009104 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009105 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9106 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9107 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9108 adding this value to the client's port.
9109
9110 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9111 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009112 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009113
9114 Examples :
9115 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9116 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009117 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009118 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9119 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9120 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009121
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009122 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9123 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9124 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9125 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9126 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9127
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009128 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9129 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009130
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009131server-state-file-name [<file>]
9132 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9133 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9134 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9135 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9136 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9137 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9138
9139 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9140 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9141
9142 global
9143 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9144
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009145 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009146 load-server-state-from-file
9147
9148 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9149 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009150
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009151server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9152 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9153 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9155 no | no | yes | yes
9156
9157 Arguments:
9158 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9159
9160 <num | range>
9161 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9162 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9163 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9164 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9165
9166 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9167
9168 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9169
9170 <params*>
9171 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9172 keyword.
9173
9174 Examples:
9175 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9176 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9177 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9178
9179 # or
9180 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9181
9182 # would be equivalent to:
9183 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9184 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9185 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9186
9187
9188
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009189source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009190source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009191source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009192 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9194 yes | no | yes | yes
9195 Arguments :
9196 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9197 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009198
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009199 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009200 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9201 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9202 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9203 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9204 supported prefixes are :
9205 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9206 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9207 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009208 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009209 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9210 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009211
9212 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9213 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009214 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9215 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9216 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009217
9218 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9219 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9220 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9221 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9222 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9223 <addr>.
9224
9225 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9226 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9227 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9228 port.
9229
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009230 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9231 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9232 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9233 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009234 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009235 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9236 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9237 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9238 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9239 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9240 HTTP header.
9241
9242 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9243 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009244 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009245 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9246 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9247 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9248 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9249 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9250 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9251 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9252
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009253 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9254 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9255 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9256 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9257 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9258 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9259
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009260 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9261 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9262 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9263 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9264
9265 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9266 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9267 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9268 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9269 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9270 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9271
9272 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9273 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9274 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9275 there are two methods :
9276
9277 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9278 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9279 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9280 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9281 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9282 of the client ranges may be used.
9283
9284 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9285 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9286 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9287 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9288 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9289 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9290 same session.
9291
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009292 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9293 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9294 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009295 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009296
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009297 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9298
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009299 Examples :
9300 backend private
9301 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9302 source 192.168.1.200
9303
9304 backend transparent_ssl1
9305 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9306 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9307
9308 backend transparent_ssl2
9309 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9310 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9311 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9312
9313 backend transparent_ssl3
9314 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9315 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9316 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9317
9318 backend transparent_smtp
9319 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9320 # with Tproxy version 4.
9321 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9322
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009323 backend transparent_http
9324 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9325 # proxy.
9326 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009328 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009329 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9330
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009331
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009332stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9333 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009335 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009336
9337 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9338 matched.
9339
9340 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9341 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9342
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009343 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9344 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009345 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009346
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009347 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9348 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9349 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9350 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009351
9352 Example :
9353 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9354 backend stats_localhost
9355 stats enable
9356 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9357
9358 Example :
9359 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9360 backend stats_auth
9361 stats enable
9362 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9363 stats admin if TRUE
9364
9365 Example :
9366 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9367 userlist stats-auth
9368 group admin users admin
9369 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9370 group readonly users haproxy
9371 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9372
9373 backend stats_auth
9374 stats enable
9375 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9376 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9377 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9378 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9379
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009380 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9381 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9382 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009383
9384
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009385stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9386 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009388 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009389 Arguments :
9390 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9391
9392 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9393
9394 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9395 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9396 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9397 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9398 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9399 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9400
9401 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9402 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9403 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009404 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009405
9406 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9407 report using "stats scope".
9408
9409 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9410 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9411 unobvious parameters.
9412
9413 Example :
9414 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9415 backend public_www
9416 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9417 stats enable
9418 stats hide-version
9419 stats scope .
9420 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009421 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009422 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9423 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9424
9425 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9426 backend private_monitoring
9427 stats enable
9428 stats uri /admin?stats
9429 stats refresh 5s
9430
9431 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9432
9433
9434stats enable
9435 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009437 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009438 Arguments : none
9439
9440 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9441 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9442 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9443 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9444 - stats auth : no authentication
9445 - stats scope : no restriction
9446
9447 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9448 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9449 unobvious parameters.
9450
9451 Example :
9452 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9453 backend public_www
9454 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9455 stats enable
9456 stats hide-version
9457 stats scope .
9458 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009459 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009460 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9461 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9462
9463 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9464 backend private_monitoring
9465 stats enable
9466 stats uri /admin?stats
9467 stats refresh 5s
9468
9469 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9470
9471
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009472stats hide-version
9473 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009475 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009476 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009477
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009478 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9479 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9480 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9481 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9482 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9483 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009484
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009485 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9486 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9487 unobvious parameters.
9488
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009489 Example :
9490 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9491 backend public_www
9492 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009493 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009494 stats hide-version
9495 stats scope .
9496 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009497 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009498 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9499 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009500
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009501 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9502 backend private_monitoring
9503 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009504 stats uri /admin?stats
9505 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009506
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009507 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009508
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009509
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009510stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9511 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9512 Access control for statistics
9513
9514 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9515 no | no | yes | yes
9516
9517 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9518 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9519 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9520 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9521 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9522 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9523
9524 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9525 instance.
9526
9527 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9528 about ACL usage.
9529
9530
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009531stats realm <realm>
9532 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009534 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009535 Arguments :
9536 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9537 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9538 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9539
9540 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9541 using a backslash ('\').
9542
9543 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9544 only related to authentication.
9545
9546 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9547 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9548 unobvious parameters.
9549
9550 Example :
9551 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9552 backend public_www
9553 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9554 stats enable
9555 stats hide-version
9556 stats scope .
9557 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009558 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009559 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9560 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9561
9562 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9563 backend private_monitoring
9564 stats enable
9565 stats uri /admin?stats
9566 stats refresh 5s
9567
9568 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9569
9570
9571stats refresh <delay>
9572 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9573 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009574 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009575 Arguments :
9576 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9577 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9578 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9579 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9580 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9581 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9582
9583 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9584 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9585 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9586 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9587
9588 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9589 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9590 unobvious parameters.
9591
9592 Example :
9593 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9594 backend public_www
9595 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9596 stats enable
9597 stats hide-version
9598 stats scope .
9599 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009600 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009601 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9602 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9603
9604 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9605 backend private_monitoring
9606 stats enable
9607 stats uri /admin?stats
9608 stats refresh 5s
9609
9610 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9611
9612
9613stats scope { <name> | "." }
9614 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009616 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009617 Arguments :
9618 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9619 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9620 section in which the statement appears.
9621
9622 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9623 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9624 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9625 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9626 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9627 exists.
9628
9629 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9630 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9631 unobvious parameters.
9632
9633 Example :
9634 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9635 backend public_www
9636 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9637 stats enable
9638 stats hide-version
9639 stats scope .
9640 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009641 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009642 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9643 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9644
9645 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9646 backend private_monitoring
9647 stats enable
9648 stats uri /admin?stats
9649 stats refresh 5s
9650
9651 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9652
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009653
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009654stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009655 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009657 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009658
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009659 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009660 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9661
9662 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9663 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9664
9665 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9666 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009667 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009668
9669 Example :
9670 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9671 backend private_monitoring
9672 stats enable
9673 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9674 stats uri /admin?stats
9675 stats refresh 5s
9676
9677 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9678 global section.
9679
9680
9681stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009682 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9684 yes | yes | yes | yes
9685 Arguments : none
9686
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009687 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009688 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9689 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9690 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9691 - IP (socket, server)
9692 - cookie (backend, server)
9693
9694 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9695 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009696 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009697
9698 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9699
9700
9701stats show-node [ <name> ]
9702 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009704 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009705 Arguments:
9706 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9707 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9708
9709 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9710 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009711 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009712
9713 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9714 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9715 unobvious parameters.
9716
9717 Example:
9718 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9719 backend private_monitoring
9720 stats enable
9721 stats show-node Europe-1
9722 stats uri /admin?stats
9723 stats refresh 5s
9724
9725 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9726 section.
9727
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009728
9729stats uri <prefix>
9730 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009732 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009733 Arguments :
9734 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9735 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9736 query string.
9737
9738 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9739 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9740 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9741 possible to reach it in the application.
9742
9743 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009744 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009745 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9746 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9747 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9748 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9749
9750 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9751 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9752 an address or a port to statistics only.
9753
9754 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9755 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9756 unobvious parameters.
9757
9758 Example :
9759 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9760 backend public_www
9761 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9762 stats enable
9763 stats hide-version
9764 stats scope .
9765 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009766 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009767 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9768 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9769
9770 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9771 backend private_monitoring
9772 stats enable
9773 stats uri /admin?stats
9774 stats refresh 5s
9775
9776 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9777
9778
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009779stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9780 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009782 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009783
9784 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009785 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009786 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009787 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009788 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9789
9790 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9791 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9792 the "stick-table" statement.
9793
9794 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9795 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9796 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9797 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9798 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9799
9800 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9801 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9802 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9803 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9804 transformation rules.
9805
9806 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9807 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9808 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9809 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9810 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9811 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9812 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9813
9814 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9815 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9816 ACL based conditions.
9817
9818 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9819 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9820 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9821 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9822
9823 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9824 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9825 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9826 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9827
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009828 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9829 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009830 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009831
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009832 Example :
9833 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9834 # last 30 minutes
9835 backend pop
9836 mode tcp
9837 balance roundrobin
9838 stick store-request src
9839 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9840 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9841 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9842
9843 backend smtp
9844 mode tcp
9845 balance roundrobin
9846 stick match src table pop
9847 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9848 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9849
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009850 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009851 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009852
9853
9854stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9855 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9857 no | no | yes | yes
9858
9859 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9860 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9861 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9862 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9863
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009864 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9865 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009866 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009867
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009868 Examples :
9869 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009870 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009871
9872 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9873 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9874 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9875
9876
9877 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9878 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9879 backend http
9880 mode http
9881 balance roundrobin
9882 stick on src table https
9883 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9884 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9885 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9886
9887 backend https
9888 mode tcp
9889 balance roundrobin
9890 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9891 stick on src
9892 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9893 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9894
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009895 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009896
9897
9898stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9899 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9901 no | no | yes | yes
9902
9903 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009904 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009905 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009906 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009907 server is selected.
9908
9909 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9910 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9911 the "stick-table" statement.
9912
9913 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9914 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9915 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9916 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9917 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9918 address.
9919
9920 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9921 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9922 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9923 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9924 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9925 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9926 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9927 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9928 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9929 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9930
9931 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9932 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9933 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9934 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9935 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9936 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9937 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9938
9939 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9940 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9941 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9942 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9943
9944 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9945 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9946 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9947 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9948 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9949 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009950 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9951 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9952 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9953 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9954 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9955 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009956
9957 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9958 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9959 the request.
9960
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009961 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9962 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009963 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009964
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009965 Example :
9966 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9967 # last 30 minutes
9968 backend pop
9969 mode tcp
9970 balance roundrobin
9971 stick store-request src
9972 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9973 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9974 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9975
9976 backend smtp
9977 mode tcp
9978 balance roundrobin
9979 stick match src table pop
9980 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9981 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9982
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009983 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009984 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009985
9986
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02009987stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009988 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
9989 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08009990 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009992 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009993
9994 Arguments :
9995 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
9996 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
9997 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
9998 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
9999
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010000 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10001 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10002 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10003 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10004
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010005 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10006 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10007 instance.
10008
10009 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10010 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10011 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10012 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10013 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10014 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010015 to 32 characters.
10016
10017 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10018 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10019 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010020 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010021 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10022 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010023
10024 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010025 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10026 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010027 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10028 increase.
10029
10030 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010031 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10032 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10033 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010034
10035 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10036 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10037 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10038 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010039 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010040 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10041 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10042 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10043 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10044 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10045 parameter (see below).
10046
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010047 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10048 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10049 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10050 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10051 soft restart.
10052
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010053 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10054 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010055
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010056 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10057 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10058 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10059 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010060 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010061 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010062 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10063 if not expiration delay is specified.
10064
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010065 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10066 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10067 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10068 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010069 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10070 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10071 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10072 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10073 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10074 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10075 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10076 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10077 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10078 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10079 types and their arguments.
10080
10081 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10082 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10083 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10084 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10085
10086 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10087 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10088 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010089 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010090
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010091 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10092 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10093 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010094 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010095 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010096 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010097
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010098 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10099 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10100 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10101 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10102
10103 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10104 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10105 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10106 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10107 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10108 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10109
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010110 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10111 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10112 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10113 they were received.
10114
10115 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10116 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10117 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10118 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10119 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10120
10121 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10122 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10123 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10124 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10125 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10126
10127 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10128 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10129 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10130
10131 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10132 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10133 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10134 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10135 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10136
10137 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10138 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10139 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10140 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10141 the client side.
10142
10143 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10144 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10145 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10146 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10147 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10148 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10149 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10150
10151 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10152 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10153 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10154 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10155 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10156 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010157 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010158
10159 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10160 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10161 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10162 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10163 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10164 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10165
10166 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010167 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010168 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10169 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10170
10171 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10172 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10173 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10174 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10175 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10176 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10177 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10178 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10179 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10180 recommended for better fairness.
10181
10182 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010183 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010184 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10185 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10186
10187 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10188 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10189 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10190 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10191 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10192 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10193 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10194 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10195 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10196 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010197
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010198 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10199 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010200 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10201 reference it.
10202
10203 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10204 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010205 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10206 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10207 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010208
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010209 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10210 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10211 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10212 something that can be ignored.
10213
10214 Example:
10215 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10216 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10217 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10218 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10219
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010220 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010221 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010222
10223
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010224stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010225 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10227 no | no | yes | yes
10228
10229 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010230 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010231 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010232 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010233 server is selected.
10234
10235 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10236 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10237 the "stick-table" statement.
10238
10239 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10240 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10241 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10242 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10243
10244 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10245 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10246 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10247 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10248 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10249 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010250 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010251 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10252 rules.
10253
10254 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10255 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10256 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10257 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10258 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10259 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10260 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10261
10262 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10263 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10264 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10265 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10266
10267 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10268 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10269 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10270 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10271 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10272 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010273 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10274 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10275 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10276 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10277 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10278 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10279 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10280 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10281 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010282
10283 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10284
10285 Example :
10286 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10287 backend https
10288 mode tcp
10289 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010290 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010291 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010292
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010293 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10294 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10295
10296 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10297 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10298 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10299
10300 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10301 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010302
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010303 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10304 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10305 # at offset 44.
10306
10307 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10308 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10309
10310 # Learn on response if server hello.
10311 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010312
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010313 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10314 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10315
10316 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10317 extraction.
10318
10319
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010320tcp-check comment <string>
10321 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10322 it fails.
10323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10324 yes | no | yes | yes
10325
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010326 Arguments :
10327 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10328 rule fails.
10329
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010330 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10331 user-friendly error reporting.
10332
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010333 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10334 "tcp-check expect".
10335
10336
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010337tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10338 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010339 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010340 Opens a new connection
10341 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010342 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010343
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010344 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010345 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10346
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010347 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010348 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010349
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010350 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010351 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10352 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010353 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010354
10355 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010356
10357 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10358
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010359 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10360
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010361 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10362
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010363 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10364
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010365 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10366 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10367 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10368 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10369
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010370 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10371 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10372 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10373 haproxy -vv.
10374
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010375 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010376
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010377 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10378 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10379 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10380
10381 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10382 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10383 of the sequence.
10384
10385 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10386 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10387 do.
10388
10389 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10390 unset-var or comment rules.
10391
10392 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010393 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10394 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10395 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10396 option tcp-check
10397 tcp-check connect
10398 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10399 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10400 tcp-check send \r\n
10401 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10402 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10403 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10404 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10405 tcp-check send \r\n
10406 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10407 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10408
10409 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10410 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010411 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010412 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10413 tcp-check connect port 143
10414 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10415 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10416
10417 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10418
10419
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010420tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010421 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010422 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010423 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010424 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010425 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010426 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010427
10428 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010429 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10430
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010431 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10432 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10433 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10434 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10435 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10436 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10437 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10438 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10439 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10440 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10441
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010442 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010443 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10444 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010445 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10446 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10447 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10448
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010449 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10450 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10451 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010452 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10453 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10454 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10455 example 404 with disable-on-404
10456 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10457 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010458 By default "L7OK" is used.
10459
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010460 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10461 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010462 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10463 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10464 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10465 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10466 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10467 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010468
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010469 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010470 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010471 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10472 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10473 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10474 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010475 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10476
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010477 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10478 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10479 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10480 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10481
10482 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10483 informational message reported in logs if an error
10484 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10485 log-format string.
10486
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010487 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10488 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10489 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10490 followed by some converters.
10491
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010492 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10493 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10494 with the usual backslash ('\').
10495 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010496 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010497 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10498 used upper or lower case.
10499
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010500 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10501
10502 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10503 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10504 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10505 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10506 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10507 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10508 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10509 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10510
10511 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10512 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10513 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10514 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10515 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10516 expression.
10517
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010518 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10519 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10520 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10521 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10522 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10523 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10524
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010525 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10526 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10527 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10528 this exact hexadecimal string.
10529 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10530
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010531 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10532 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10533 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10534 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10535 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10536 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10537 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10538 size.
10539
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010540 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10541 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10542 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10543 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10544 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10545 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10546 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10547 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10548 in a binary string before matching the response's
10549 buffer.
10550
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010551 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10552 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10553 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10554 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10555 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10556 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10557 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10558 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10559 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10560 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10561 the null character.
10562
10563 Examples :
10564 # perform a POP check
10565 option tcp-check
10566 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10567
10568 # perform an IMAP check
10569 option tcp-check
10570 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10571
10572 # look for the redis master server
10573 option tcp-check
10574 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010575 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010576 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10577 tcp-check expect string role:master
10578 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10579 tcp-check expect string +OK
10580
10581
10582 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10583 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10584
10585
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010586tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10587tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10588 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10589 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010590 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010591 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010592
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010593 Arguments :
10594 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10595
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010596 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10597 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010598
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010599 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10600 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010601
10602 Examples :
10603 # look for the redis master server
10604 option tcp-check
10605 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10606 tcp-check expect string role:master
10607
10608 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10609 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10610
10611
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010612tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10613tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10614 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10615 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010616 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010617 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010618
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010619 Arguments :
10620 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010621
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010622 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10623 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010624
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010625 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10626 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10627 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010628
10629 Examples :
10630 # redis check in binary
10631 option tcp-check
10632 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10633 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10634
10635
10636 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10637 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10638
10639
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010640tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010641 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010642 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010643 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010644
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010645 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010646 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10647 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10648 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10649 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10650 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10651 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10652 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10653 and '-'.
10654
10655 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10656
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010657 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010658 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10659
10660
10661tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010662 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010663 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010664 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010665
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010666 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010667 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10668 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10669 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10670 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10671 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10672 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10673 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10674 and '-'.
10675
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010676 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010677 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10678
10679
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010680tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10681 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10683 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010684 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010685 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10686 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010687
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010688 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010689
10690 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10691 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010692 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10693 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10694 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10695 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10696 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10697 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010698
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010699 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10700 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10701 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10702 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010703
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010704 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010705 - accept :
10706 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10707 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10708 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010709
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010710 - reject :
10711 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10712 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10713 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10714 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10715 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10716 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10717 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10718 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10719 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10720 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10721 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010722 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010723
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010724 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10725 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10726 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10727 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10728 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10729 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10730 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10731 hosts.
10732
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010733 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10734 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10735 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10736 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10737 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10738 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10739 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10740 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10741
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010742 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10743 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10744 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10745 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10746 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10747 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10748 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10749 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10750 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010751 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10752 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010753
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010754 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010755 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010756 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10757 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10758 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010759 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010760 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10761 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10762 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10763 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10764 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10765 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10766 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10767 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010768
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010769 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010770 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010771 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010772 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010773 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10774 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10775 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010776
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010777 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10778 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10779 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10780 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010781
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010782 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10783 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10784 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10785 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10786 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010787 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10788 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10789 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10790 layer7 information is extracted.
10791
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010792 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10793 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10794 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10795 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10796 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010797
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010798 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10799 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10800 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10801 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10802
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010803 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10804 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10805 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10806 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10807
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010808 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10809 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10810 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10811 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10812 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010813
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010814 - set-src <expr> :
10815 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10816 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10817 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010818 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010819
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010820 Arguments:
10821 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10822 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010823
10824 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010825 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10826
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010827 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10828 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010829
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010830 - set-src-port <expr> :
10831 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10832 expression.
10833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010834 Arguments:
10835 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10836 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010837
10838 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010839 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10840
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010841 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10842 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10843 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010844
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010845 - set-dst <expr> :
10846 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10847 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10848 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10849 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10850 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10851
10852 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10853 followed by some converters.
10854
10855 Example:
10856
10857 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10858 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10859
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010860 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10861 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10862
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010863 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10864 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10865 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10866 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10867
10868
10869 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10870 followed by some converters.
10871
10872 Example:
10873
10874 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10875
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010876 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10877 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10878 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10879
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010880 - "silent-drop" :
10881 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010882 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010883 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10884 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10885 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10886 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10887 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010888 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10889 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010890 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10891 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010892 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010893 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10894 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10895 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10896 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10897
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010898 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10899 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10900 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010901
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010902 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10903 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10904 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010905
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010906 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010907 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010908 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010909
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010910 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10911 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10912 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010913
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010914 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010915 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10916 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010917
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010918 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10919
10920 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10921
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010922 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10923
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010924 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010925
10926
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010927tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10928 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010930 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010931 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010932 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10933 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010934
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010935 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010936
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010937 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010938 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10939 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10940 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10941 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010942
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010943 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10944 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10945 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10946 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010947 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10948 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10949 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10950 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10951 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10952 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010953 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010954 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010955
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010956 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10957 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10958 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10959 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010960
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010961 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010962 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010963 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010964 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10965 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040010966 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010967 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010968 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010969 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010970 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020010971 - set-dst <expr>
10972 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010973 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010974 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010975 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010976 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010010977 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010978
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010979 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
10980 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010981 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
10982 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010983
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010984 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
10985 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
10986 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
10987 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
10988 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
10989 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010990
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010991 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010992 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10993 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010994
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010995 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020010996 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
10997 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
10998 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
10999 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011000 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11001 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11002 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011003
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011004 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011005 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11006 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11007 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011008
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011009 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11010 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11011
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011012 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011013 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11014 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011015
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011016 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11017 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011018 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011019 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11020 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011021 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011022 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011023 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011024 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11025 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011026 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011027 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11028 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011029
11030 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11031 followed by some converters.
11032
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011033 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11034 <var-name>.
11035
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011036 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11037 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11038 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11039 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11040 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11041
11042 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11043 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11044 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11045 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11046 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11047 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11048 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11049 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11050 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11051 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11052 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11053
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011054 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11055 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11056 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11057 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11058 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11059
11060 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11061
11062 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11063
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011064 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11065 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11066 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11067 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11068 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11069 evaluated.
11070
11071 Example:
11072 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11073
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011074 Example:
11075
11076 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011077 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011078
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011079 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011080 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11081 # and reject everything else.
11082 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11083 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011084 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011085 tcp-request content reject
11086
11087 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011088 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11089 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11090 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011091 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011092
11093 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11094 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11095 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011096 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011097 tcp-request content reject
11098
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011099 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011100 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011101 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011102 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011103 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11104 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011105
11106 Example:
11107 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11108 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011109 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011110
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011111 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011112 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011113
11114 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011115 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011116 # protecting all our sites
11117 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011118 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11119 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011120 ...
11121 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11122
11123 backend http_dynamic
11124 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011125 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011126 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011127 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011128 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011129 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011130 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011132 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011133
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011134 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11135 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011136
11137
11138tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11139 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011141 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011142 Arguments :
11143 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11144 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11145 as explained at the top of this document.
11146
11147 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11148 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11149 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11150 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11151 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11152
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011153 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11154 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11155 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11156 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11157
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011158 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11159 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011160 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011161 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011162 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11163 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11164 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11165 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011166
11167 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11168 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11169 it pass through unaffected.
11170
11171 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11172 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11173 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011174 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011175 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11176 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011177 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11178 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11179 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011180
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011181 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011182 "timeout client".
11183
11184
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011185tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11186 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11187 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11188 no | no | yes | yes
11189 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011190 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11191 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011192
11193 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11194
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011195 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011196 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11197 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011198 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11199 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011200
11201 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11202
11203 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11204 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11205 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11206 inserted.
11207
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011208 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011209 - accept :
11210 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11211 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11212 the rules evaluation.
11213
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011214 - close :
11215 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11216 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11217 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11218 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11219 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11220 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011221 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011222 protocols.
11223
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011224 - reject :
11225 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11226 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011227 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011228
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011229 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11230 Sets a variable.
11231
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011232 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11233 Unsets a variable.
11234
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011235 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11236 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11237 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11238 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11239
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011240 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11241 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11242 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11243 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11244
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011245 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11246 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11247 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11248 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11249 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011250
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011251 - "silent-drop" :
11252 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011253 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011254 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11255 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11256 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11257 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11258 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011259 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11260 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011261 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11262 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011263 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011264 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11265 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11266 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11267 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11268
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011269 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11270 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11271
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011272 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11273 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11274 for changing the default action to a reject.
11275
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011276 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11277 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11278 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11279 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011280 period.
11281
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011282 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11283 declared inline.
11284
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011285 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11286 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011287 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011288 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11289 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011290 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011291 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011292 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011293 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11294 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011295 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011296 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11297 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011298
11299 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11300 followed by some converters.
11301
11302 Example:
11303
11304 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11305
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011306 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11307 <var-name>.
11308
11309 Example:
11310
11311 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11312
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011313 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11314 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11315 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11316 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11317 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11318
11319 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11320
11321 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11322
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011323 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11324
11325 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11326
11327
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011328tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11329 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11331 no | yes | yes | no
11332 Arguments :
11333 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11334 below.
11335
11336 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11337
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011338 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011339 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11340 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11341 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11342 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11343 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11344 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11345 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011346 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011347 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11348 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11349 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11350 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11351 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11352 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11353 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11354 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11355 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11356 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11357 instead.
11358
11359 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11360 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11361 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11362 rules which may be inserted.
11363
11364 Several types of actions are supported :
11365 - accept : the request is accepted
11366 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11367 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11368 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011369 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011370 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011371 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011372 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011373 - silent-drop
11374
11375 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11376 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11377 sections for a complete description.
11378
11379 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11380 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11381 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11382
11383 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11384 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11385 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11386 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11387 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11388
11389 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11390 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11391
11392 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11393 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11394 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11395
11396 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11397 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11398 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11399
11400 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11401 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11402 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11403
11404 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11405 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11406 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11407
11408 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11409
11410 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11411
11412
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011413tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11414 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11416 no | no | yes | yes
11417 Arguments :
11418 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11419 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11420 as explained at the top of this document.
11421
11422 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11423
11424
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011425timeout check <timeout>
11426 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11427 established.
11428
11429 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11430 yes | no | yes | yes
11431 Arguments:
11432 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11433 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11434 as explained at the top of this document.
11435
11436 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11437 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011438 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011439 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011440 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11441 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11442 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011443
11444 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11445 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11446
11447 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11448 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011449 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011450
11451 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11452 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11453 forget about it.
11454
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011455 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11456 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011457
11458
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011459timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011460 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11462 yes | yes | yes | no
11463 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011464 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011465 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11466 as explained at the top of this document.
11467
11468 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11469 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11470 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011471 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11472 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11473 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11474 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011475 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11476 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11477 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011478 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011479 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011480 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11481 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011482 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11483 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011484
11485 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11486 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11487 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11488 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011489 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011490 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11491
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011492 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011493
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011494 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011495
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011496
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011497timeout client-fin <timeout>
11498 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11500 yes | yes | yes | no
11501 Arguments :
11502 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11503 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11504 as explained at the top of this document.
11505
11506 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11507 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11508 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11509 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11510 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11511 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11512 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011513 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11514 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11515 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011516
11517 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11518 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11519 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11520
11521 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11522
11523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011524timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011525 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11527 yes | no | yes | yes
11528 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011529 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011530 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11531 as explained at the top of this document.
11532
11533 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011534 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011535 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011536 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011537 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11538 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011539
11540 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11541 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11542 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11543 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011544 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011545 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11546
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011547 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011548
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011549
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011550timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11551 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11553 yes | yes | yes | yes
11554 Arguments :
11555 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11556 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11557 as explained at the top of this document.
11558
11559 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11560 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11561 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11562 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11563 once the request has started to present itself.
11564
11565 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11566 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11567 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11568 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11569 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11570
11571 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11572 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11573 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11574 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11575
11576 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11577 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011578 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011579 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11580 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011581 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011582
11583 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11584 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11585 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11586 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11587
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011588 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11589 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011590 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11591
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011592 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11593
11594
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011595timeout http-request <timeout>
11596 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011598 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011599 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011600 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011601 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11602 as explained at the top of this document.
11603
11604 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11605 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11606 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11607 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11608 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11609 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11610 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011611 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11612 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11613 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11614 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011615 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011616 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11617 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011618
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011619 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11620 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11621 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11622 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11623 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011624 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011625
11626 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11627 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011628 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011629 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11630 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11631
11632 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011633 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11634 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11635 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011636
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011637 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011638 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011639
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011640
11641timeout queue <timeout>
11642 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11644 yes | no | yes | yes
11645 Arguments :
11646 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11647 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11648 as explained at the top of this document.
11649
11650 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11651 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11652 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11653 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11654 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11655
11656 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11657 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11658 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11659 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11660
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011661 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011662
11663
11664timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011665 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11667 yes | no | yes | yes
11668 Arguments :
11669 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11670 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11671 as explained at the top of this document.
11672
11673 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11674 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11675 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11676 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11677 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11678 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11679 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11680
11681 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11682 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11683 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11684 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11685 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011686 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011687 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011688 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11689 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011690 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11691 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011692
11693 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11694 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11695 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11696 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011697 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011698 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11699
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011700 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011701
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011702
11703timeout server-fin <timeout>
11704 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11706 yes | no | yes | yes
11707 Arguments :
11708 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11709 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11710 as explained at the top of this document.
11711
11712 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11713 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11714 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11715 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11716 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11717 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11718 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11719 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11720 situations, it should not be needed.
11721
11722 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11723 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11724 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11725
11726 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11727
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011728
11729timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011730 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11732 yes | yes | yes | yes
11733 Arguments :
11734 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11735 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11736 as explained at the top of this document.
11737
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011738 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11739 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11740 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011741
11742 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11743 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11744 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11745 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011746 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011747
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011748 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011749
11750
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011751timeout tunnel <timeout>
11752 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11754 yes | no | yes | yes
11755 Arguments :
11756 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11757 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11758 as explained at the top of this document.
11759
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011760 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011761 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11762 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11763 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011764 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11765 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011766 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11767 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11768 specified.
11769
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011770 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11771 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11772 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11773 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11774 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11775 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11776 state.
11777
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011778 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11779 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11780 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11781 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011782 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011783
11784 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11785 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11786 forget about it.
11787
11788 Example :
11789 defaults http
11790 option http-server-close
11791 timeout connect 5s
11792 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011793 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011794 timeout server 30s
11795 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11796
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011797 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011798
11799
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011800transparent (deprecated)
11801 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011803 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011804 Arguments : none
11805
11806 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11807 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11808 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11809 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11810 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11811 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11812 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11813 appropriate server.
11814
11815 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11816
11817 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11818 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11819
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011820 See also: "option transparent"
11821
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011822unique-id-format <string>
11823 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11825 yes | yes | yes | no
11826 Arguments :
11827 <string> is a log-format string.
11828
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011829 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11830 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11831 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11832 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011833
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011834 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11835 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11836 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11837 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11838 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11839 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11840 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11841 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011842
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011843 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11844 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011845
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011846 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011847
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011848 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011849
11850 will generate:
11851
11852 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11853
11854 See also: "unique-id-header"
11855
11856unique-id-header <name>
11857 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11859 yes | yes | yes | no
11860 Arguments :
11861 <name> is the name of the header.
11862
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011863 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11864 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011865
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011866 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011867
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011868 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011869 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11870
11871 will generate:
11872
11873 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11874
11875 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011876
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011877use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011878 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11880 no | yes | yes | no
11881 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011882 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11883 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011884
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011885 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11886 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011887
11888 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11889 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11890 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011891 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011892 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011893 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11894 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011895
11896 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11897 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11898 assign the backend.
11899
11900 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11901 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11902 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11903 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11904 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11905 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11906
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011907 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011908 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011909 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11910 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11911 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11912
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011913 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11914 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11915 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11916 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11917 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11918 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11919 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11920 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11921 cannot be forced from the request.
11922
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011923 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011924 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11925 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11926
11927 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11928 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011929
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011930use-fcgi-app <name>
11931 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11933 no | no | yes | yes
11934 Arguments :
11935 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11936
11937 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011938
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011939use-server <server> if <condition>
11940use-server <server> unless <condition>
11941 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11943 no | no | yes | yes
11944 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011945 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11946 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011947
11948 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11949
11950 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11951 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11952 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11953
11954 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11955 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11956 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11957 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11958 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11959 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11960 matches will assign the server.
11961
11962 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11963 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11964 with the next rules until one matches.
11965
11966 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
11967 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11968 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
11969 according to other persistence mechanisms.
11970
11971 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
11972 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
11973 stripped.
11974
11975 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
11976 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
11977 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
11978 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
11979
11980 Example :
11981 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
11982 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
11983 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
11984 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
11985 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
11986 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000011987 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011988 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
11989 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
11990
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011991 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
11992 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
11993 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
11994 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
11995 was conditionned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
11996 and we fall back to load balancing.
11997
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011998 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011999
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012000
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120015. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012002--------------------------
12003
12004The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12005depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12006settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12007written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12008described in this section.
12009
12010
120115.1. Bind options
12012-----------------
12013
12014The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12015as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12016no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12017parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12018while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12019provided immediately after the setting name.
12020
12021The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12022
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012023accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12024 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12025 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12026 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12027 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12028 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12029 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12030 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12031 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12032 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012033 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12034 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12035 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012036
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012037accept-proxy
12038 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012039 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12040 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012041 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12042 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12043 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12044 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012045 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012046 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12047 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012048 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12049 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012050
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012051allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012052 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012053 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012054 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012055 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12056 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012057
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012058alpn <protocols>
12059 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12060 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12061 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012062 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012063 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012064 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12065 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12066 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12067 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12068 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12069 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12070 preference, like below :
12071
12072 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012073
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012074backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012075 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012076 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12077
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012078curves <curves>
12079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12080 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12081 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12082 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12083 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12084 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12085
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012086ecdhe <named curve>
12087 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012088 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12089 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012090
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012091ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012092 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12093 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12094 client's certificate.
12095
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012096ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12097 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12098 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12099 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12100 error is ignored.
12101
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012102ca-sign-file <cafile>
12103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12104 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12105 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12106 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12107 'generate-certificates' for details.
12108
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012109ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012110 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12111 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12112 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12113 'generate-certificates' for details.
12114
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012115ca-verify-file <cafile>
12116 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12117 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12118 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12119 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12120 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12121
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012122ciphers <ciphers>
12123 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12124 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012125 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012126 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012127 information and recommendations see e.g.
12128 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12129 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12130 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12131
12132ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12133 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12134 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12135 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12136 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012137 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12138 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012139
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012140crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012141 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12142 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12143 to verify client's certificate.
12144
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012145crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012146 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12147 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12148 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12149 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12150 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012151 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12152 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012153
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012154 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12155 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12156
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012157 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12158 are loaded.
12159
12160 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012161 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12162 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12163 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12164 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12165 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12166 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12167 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012168 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012169
12170 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12171 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12172 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12173 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012174 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12175 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012176
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012177 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012178
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012179 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012180 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012181 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12182 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012183 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12184 clients).
12185
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012186 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12187 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12188 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12189 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12190 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12191 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12192 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12193 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12194 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12195 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12196 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12197 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12198 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12199
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012200 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12201 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12202 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12203 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12204 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12205
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012206 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12207 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12208 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12209 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012210
12211 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12212 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12213 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12214 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12215 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12216 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12217 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12218 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12219 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12220
12221 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12222
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012223 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012224 a cert bundle.
12225
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012226 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012227 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12228 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12229 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12230 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12231 provide multi-cert support.
12232
12233 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12234
12235 Filename | CN | SAN
12236 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12237 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012238 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012239 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12240 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12241
12242 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12243 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12244 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12245 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012246 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12247 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12248 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012249
12250 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12251 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12252
12253 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12254 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12255 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12256
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012257crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012258 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012259 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012260 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012261 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012262
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012263crt-list <file>
12264 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012265 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12266 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012267
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012268 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12269
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012270 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12271 "no-ca-names", "crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With
12272 BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also
12273 supported. It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012274
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012275 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12276 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12277 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12278 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12279 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12280 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12281 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12282 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012283
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012284 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012285 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012286 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12287 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12288 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012289
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012290 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12291
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012292 crt-list file example:
12293 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012294 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012295 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012296 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012297 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012298
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012299defer-accept
12300 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12301 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12302 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012303 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012304 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12305 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12306 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12307 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12308 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12309 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12310 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12311
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012312expose-fd listeners
12313 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12314 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012315 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12316 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012317 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012318
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012319force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012320 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012321 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012322 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012323 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012324
12325force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012326 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012327 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012328 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012329
12330force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012331 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012332 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012333 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012334
12335force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012336 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012337 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012338 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012339
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012340force-tlsv13
12341 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12342 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012343 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012344
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012345generate-certificates
12346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12347 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12348 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12349 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12350 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12351 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12352 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12353 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12354 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12355 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12356 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12357
12358 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12359 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012360 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012361 certificate is used many times.
12362
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012363gid <gid>
12364 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12365 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12366 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12367 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12368 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12369
12370group <group>
12371 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12372 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12373 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12374 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12375 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12376
12377id <id>
12378 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12379 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12380 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12381 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12382
12383interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012384 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12385 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12386 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12387 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12388 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12389 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012390 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12391 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12392 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12393 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12394 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12395 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012396
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012397level <level>
12398 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12399 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12400 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012401 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012402 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12403 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12404 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012405 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012406 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012407 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012408 all counters).
12409
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012410severity-output <format>
12411 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12412 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12413 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12414 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12415 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12416 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12417 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12418 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12419 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12420 rfc5424 convention.
12421
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012422maxconn <maxconn>
12423 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12424 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12425 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12426 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12427 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12428 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12429 eat all memory.
12430
12431mode <mode>
12432 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12433 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12434 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12435 UNIX sockets.
12436
12437mss <maxseg>
12438 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12439 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12440 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12441 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12442 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12443 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12444 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12445 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12446 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12447 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12448 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12449
12450name <name>
12451 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12452 page.
12453
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012454namespace <name>
12455 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12456 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12457 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12458 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12459
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012460nice <nice>
12461 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12462 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12463 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12464 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12465 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12466 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12467 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12468 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12469 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12470 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12471 one for an RDP socket.
12472
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012473no-ca-names
12474 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12475 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012476 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012477
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012478no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012480 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012481 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012482 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012483 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12484 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012485
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012486no-tls-tickets
12487 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12488 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12489 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012490 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12491 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012492 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12493 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12494 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012495
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012496no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012497 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012498 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012499 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012500 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012501 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12502 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012503
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012504no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012505 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012506 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012507 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012508 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012509 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12510 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012511
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012512no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012513 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012514 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012515 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012516 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012517 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12518 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012519
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012520no-tlsv13
12521 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12522 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12523 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12524 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012525 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12526 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012527
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012528npn <protocols>
12529 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12530 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12531 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012532 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012533 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012534 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12535 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12536 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12537 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12538 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012539
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012540prefer-client-ciphers
12541 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12542 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12543 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012544 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12545 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12546 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012547
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012548process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012549 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012550 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012551 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012552 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12553 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12554 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12555 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012556 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012557 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12558 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12559 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12560 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12561 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012562
12563 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12564
12565 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12566 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12567 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12568 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12569 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12570 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12571 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12572 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012573
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012574proto <name>
12575 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12576 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12577 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12578 in haproxy -vv.
12579 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12580 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012581 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012582 h2" on the bind line.
12583
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012584ssl
12585 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012586 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012587 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12588 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012589 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12590 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012591
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012592ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12593 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012594 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12595 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12596 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012597 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12598
12599ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012600 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12601 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12602 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12603 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012604
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012605strict-sni
12606 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12607 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12608 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12609 See the "crt" option for more information.
12610
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012611tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012612 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012613 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12614 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012615 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012616 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12617 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12618 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12619 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12620 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12621 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12622 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12623
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012624tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012625 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012626 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12627 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12628 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12629 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12630 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12631 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12632 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012633 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12634 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12635 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012636
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012637tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12638 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012639 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12640 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12641 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12642 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12643 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12644 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12645 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12646 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12647 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12648 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012649 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12650 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12651
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012652transparent
12653 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12654 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12655 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12656 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12657 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12658 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12659 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12660 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12661 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12662 so check for support with your vendor.
12663
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012664v4v6
12665 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12666 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12667 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12668 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012669 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012670
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012671v6only
12672 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12673 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12674 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012675 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12676 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012677
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012678uid <uid>
12679 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12680 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12681 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12682 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12683 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12684
12685user <user>
12686 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12687 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12688 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12689 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12690 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12691
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012692verify [none|optional|required]
12693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12694 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12695 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12696 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12697 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012698 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12699 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12700 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12701 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012702
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200127035.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012704------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012706The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12707which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12708arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12709settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12710after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12711Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12712address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012713
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012714 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012715 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012716
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012717Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12718keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12719
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012720The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012721
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012722addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012723 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012724 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12725 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12726 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12727 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12728 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012729
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012730agent-check
12731 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012732 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012733 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12734 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12735 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012736
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012737 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012738 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012739 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12740 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12741 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012742
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012743 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12744 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12745 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12746 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12747 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012748
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012749 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012750 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012751
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012752 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12753 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12754 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012755
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012756 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12757 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12758 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012759
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012760 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12761 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12762 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12763 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12764 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012765 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012766 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012767
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012768 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12769 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012770
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012771 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12772 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12773 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12774 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12775 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12776 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12777 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12778 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12779 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012780
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012781 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12782 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012783 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12784 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12785 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012786 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012787
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012788 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012789 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012790
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012791agent-send <string>
12792 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12793 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12794 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12795 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12796 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12797
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012798agent-inter <delay>
12799 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12800 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12801
12802 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12803 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12804 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12805 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12806 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12807 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12808 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12809 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12810 of backends use the same servers.
12811
12812 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12813
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012814agent-addr <addr>
12815 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12816
12817 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12818 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12819 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12820 hostname, it will be resolved.
12821
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012822agent-port <port>
12823 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12824
12825 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12826
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012827allow-0rtt
12828 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012829 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12830 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012831
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012832alpn <protocols>
12833 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12834 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12835 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012836 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012837 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12838 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12839 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12840 now obsolete NPN extension.
12841 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12842 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12843
12844 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12845
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012846backup
12847 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12848 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12849 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12850 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012851 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12852 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012853
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012854ca-file <cafile>
12855 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12856 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12857 server's certificate.
12858
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012859check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012860 This option enables health checks on a server:
12861 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12862 considered available.
12863 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12864 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12865 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12866 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12867 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12868 set.
12869 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12870 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12871 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12872 exchanges succeed.
12873
12874 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12875 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12876 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12877 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12878 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050012879 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012880 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12881
12882 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12883 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12884
12885 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12886 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12887
12888 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12889 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12890 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12891 available.
12892
12893 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12894 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12895 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12896
12897 Example:
12898 # simple tcp check
12899 backend foo
12900 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12901 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12902 backend foo
12903 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12904 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12905 backend foo
12906 option tcp-check
12907 tcp-check connect
12908 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012909
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012910check-send-proxy
12911 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12912 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12913 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12914 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12915 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12916 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12917 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12918
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012919check-alpn <protocols>
12920 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12921 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12922 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12923
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012924check-proto <name>
12925 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
12926 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
12927 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
12928 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
12929 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12930 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
12931 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
12932
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012933check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012934 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012935 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12936 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012937
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012938check-ssl
12939 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12940 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12941 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12942 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012943 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012944 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12945 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012946 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012947 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12948 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012949
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012950check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012951 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012952 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12953 for normal traffic.
12954
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012955ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12957 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12958 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012959 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12960 information and recommendations see e.g.
12961 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12962 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12963 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012964
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012965ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12966 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12967 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
12968 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
12969 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012970 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
12971 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
12972 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012973
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012974cookie <value>
12975 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
12976 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
12977 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
12978 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
12979 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
12980 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
12981 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
12982
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012983crl-file <crlfile>
12984 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12985 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12986 to verify server's certificate.
12987
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020012988crt <cert>
12989 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12990 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
12991 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
12992 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
12993 certificate request.
12994
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020012995disabled
12996 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
12997 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
12998 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
12999 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13000 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013001 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013002
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013003enabled
13004 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13005 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13006 default value.
13007 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13008 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013010error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013011 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13012 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13013 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013014
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013015 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013016
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013017fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013018 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13019 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13020 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13021
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013022force-sslv3
13023 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13024 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013025 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013026 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013027
13028force-tlsv10
13029 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013030 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013031 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013032
13033force-tlsv11
13034 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013035 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013036 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013037
13038force-tlsv12
13039 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013040 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013041 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013042
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013043force-tlsv13
13044 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13045 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013046 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013048id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013049 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13050 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13051 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013052
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013053init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13054 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13055 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013056 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013057 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13058 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13059 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13060 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13061 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13062 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13063 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13064 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13065 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013066 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013067 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13068 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13069 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13070 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13071 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13072 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013073 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013074
13075 Example:
13076 defaults
13077 # never fail on address resolution
13078 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013080inter <delay>
13081fastinter <delay>
13082downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013083 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13084 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13085 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13086 between checks depending on the server state :
13087
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013088 Server state | Interval used
13089 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13090 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13091 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13092 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13093 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13094 or yet unchecked. |
13095 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13096 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13097 | "inter" otherwise.
13098 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013100 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13101 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13102 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13103 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013104 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13105 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13106 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13107 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13108 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013109
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013110log-proto <logproto>
13111 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13112 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13113 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13114 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13115
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013116maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013117 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13118 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013119 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13120 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013121 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13122 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13123 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13124 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13125
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013126 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13127 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13128 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13129 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13130 than 50 concurrent requests.
13131
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013132maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013133 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13134 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13135 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13136 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13137 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13138 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13139 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13140
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013141max-reuse <count>
13142 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13143 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13144 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13145 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13146 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13147 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13148 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13149 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013151minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013152 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13153 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13154 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13155 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13156 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13157 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013158 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013159 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013160
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013161namespace <name>
13162 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13163 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13164 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13165 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13166
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013167no-agent-check
13168 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13169 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13170 default value.
13171 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13172 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13173
13174no-backup
13175 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13176 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13177 default value.
13178 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13179 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13180
13181no-check
13182 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13183 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13184 default value.
13185 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13186 "default-server" "check" setting.
13187
13188no-check-ssl
13189 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13190 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13191 default value.
13192 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13193 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13194
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013195no-send-proxy
13196 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13197 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13198 default value.
13199 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13200 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13201
13202no-send-proxy-v2
13203 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13204 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13205 default value.
13206 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13207 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13208
13209no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13210 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13211 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13212 default value.
13213 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13214 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13215
13216no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13217 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13218 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13219 default value.
13220 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13221 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13222
13223no-ssl
13224 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13225 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13226 default value.
13227 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13228 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13229
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013230no-ssl-reuse
13231 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13232 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13233 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13234 and for paranoid users.
13235
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013236no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013237 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13238 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013239 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013240
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013241 Supported in default-server: No
13242
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013243no-tls-tickets
13244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13245 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13246 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013247 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13248 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013249 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13250 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13251 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013252 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013253
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013254no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013255 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013256 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13257 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013258 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13259 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013260 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013261
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013262 Supported in default-server: No
13263
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013264no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013265 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013266 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13267 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013268 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13269 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013270 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013271
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013272 Supported in default-server: No
13273
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013274no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013275 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013276 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13277 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013278 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13279 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013280 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013281
13282 Supported in default-server: No
13283
13284no-tlsv13
13285 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13286 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13287 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13288 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13289 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013290 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013291
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013292 Supported in default-server: No
13293
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013294no-verifyhost
13295 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13296 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13297 default value.
13298 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13299 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013300
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013301no-tfo
13302 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13303 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13304 default value.
13305 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13306 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13307
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013308non-stick
13309 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13310 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13311 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13312
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013313npn <protocols>
13314 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13315 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13316 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013317 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013318 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13319 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13320 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013322observe <mode>
13323 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13324 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13325 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13326 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13327 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13328 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013329 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013330
13331 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13332
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013333on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013334 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13335 Currently, four modes are available:
13336 - fastinter: force fastinter
13337 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13338 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13339 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13340 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13341
13342 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13343
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013344on-marked-down <action>
13345 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13346 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013347 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13348 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13349 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13350 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13351 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13352 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13353 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13354 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013355
13356 Actions are disabled by default
13357
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013358on-marked-up <action>
13359 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13360 Currently one action is available:
13361 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13362 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13363 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13364 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013365 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13366 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013367 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13368 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13369
13370 Actions are disabled by default
13371
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013372pool-max-conn <max>
13373 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13374 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13375 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13376 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13377 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13378 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13379
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013380pool-purge-delay <delay>
13381 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013382 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013383 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013385port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013386 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13387 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13388 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13389 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13390 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13391 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13392
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013393proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013394 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13395 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13396 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13397 reported in haproxy -vv.
13398 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
13399 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13400
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013401redir <prefix>
13402 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13403 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13404 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13405 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13406 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13407 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13408 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13409 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013410 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013411 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013412 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13413 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13414 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13415 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13416
13417 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13418
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013419rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013420 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13421 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13422 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13423
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013424resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13425 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13426 server.
13427
13428 Available options:
13429
13430 * allow-dup-ip
13431 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13432 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13433 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13434 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13435 For such case, simply enable this option.
13436 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13437
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013438 * ignore-weight
13439 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13440 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13441 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13442
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013443 * prevent-dup-ip
13444 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13445 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13446 same fqdn.
13447 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13448
13449 Example:
13450 backend b_myapp
13451 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13452 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13453 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13454
13455 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13456 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13457 it
13458 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13459 different address
13460
13461 Default value: not set
13462
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013463resolve-prefer <family>
13464 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13465 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13466 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13467 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13468
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013469 Default value: ipv6
13470
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013471 Example:
13472
13473 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013474
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013475resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013476 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013477 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013478 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013479 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13480 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013481 configured network, another address is selected.
13482
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013483 Example:
13484
13485 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013486
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013487resolvers <id>
13488 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13489 hostname.
13490
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013491 Example:
13492
13493 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013494
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013495 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013496
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013497send-proxy
13498 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13499 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13500 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13501 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013502 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13503 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13504 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13505 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13506 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13507 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13508 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13509 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13510 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13511 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013512 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13513 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013514
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013515send-proxy-v2
13516 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13517 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13518 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13519 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013520 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13521 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13522 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13523 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013524
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013525proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013526 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13527 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13528
13529 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13530 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13531 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13532 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13533 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13534 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13535 connection is supported).
13536 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13537 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13538 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13539 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13540 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13541 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13542 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013543
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013544send-proxy-v2-ssl
13545 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13546 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13547 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13548 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13549 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13550 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13551 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013552 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13553 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013554
13555send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13556 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13557 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13558 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13559 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13560 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13561 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13562 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13563 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013564 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13565 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013567slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013568 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13569 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13570 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13571 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13572 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13573 parameters :
13574
13575 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13576 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13577
13578 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13579 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13580 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13581 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13582
13583 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13584 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13585 seen as failed.
13586
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013587sni <expression>
13588 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13589 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13590 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13591 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013592 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13593 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013594 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013595 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13596 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013597
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013598source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013599source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013600source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013601 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13602 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13603 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13604 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13605
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013606 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13607 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13608 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13609 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13610 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13611 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13612 server.
13613
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013614 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13615 specifying the source address without port(s).
13616
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013617ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013618 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13619 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13620 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13621 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13622 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13623 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013624 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13625 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013626
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013627ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13628 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13629 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13630 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13631
13632ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13633 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13634 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13635 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13636
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013637ssl-reuse
13638 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13639 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13640 default value.
13641 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13642 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13643
13644stick
13645 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13646 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13647 default value.
13648 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13649 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013650
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013651socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013652 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013653 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13654 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13655
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013656tcp-ut <delay>
13657 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13658 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13659 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013660 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013661 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13662 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13663 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13664 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13665 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13666 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13667 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13668 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13669 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13670
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013671tfo
13672 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13673 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13674 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13675 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13676 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013677 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013679track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013680 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13681 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13682 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13683 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013684 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13685
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013686tls-tickets
13687 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13688 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13689 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013690 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13691 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13692 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013693 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013694 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013695
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013696verify [none|required]
13697 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013698 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013699 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13700 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013701 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013702 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13703 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13704 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13705 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13706 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13707 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13708 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13709 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013710
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013711verifyhost <hostname>
13712 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013713 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13714 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13715 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13716 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13717 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13718 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13719 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13720 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013721
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013722weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013723 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13724 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13725 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013726 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13727 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13728 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13729 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13730 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13731 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013732
13733
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137345.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13735-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013736
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013737HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13738using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13739configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013740This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13741can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13742workload.
13743This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13744resolution at run time.
13745Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13746carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13747
13748
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137495.3.1. Global overview
13750----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013751
13752As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13753different steps of the process life:
13754
13755 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13756 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13757 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13758
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013759 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13760 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013761
13762A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13763 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13764 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13765 resolution to know this new IP.
13766
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013767When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013768HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013769SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13770from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13771will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13772will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013773
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013774A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013775 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013776 first valid response.
13777
13778 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13779 servers return an error.
13780
13781
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137825.3.2. The resolvers section
13783----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013784
13785This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013786HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13787contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013788
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013789When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13790uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13791is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13792answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13793
13794When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013795used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013796
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013797 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13798 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13799 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013800
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013801 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13802 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013803
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013804 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13805 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13806 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013807
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013808For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13809following scenarios are possible:
13810
13811 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13812 ignored
13813
13814 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13815 applied
13816
13817 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13818 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13819
13820 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13821 retries the query with a new type
13822
13823 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13824 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013825
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013826As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13827a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013828<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013829
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013830
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013831resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013832 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013833
13834A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13835
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013836accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013837 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013838 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013839 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13840 by RFC 6891)
13841
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013842 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13843
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013844nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13845 DNS server description:
13846 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13847 <ip> : IP address of the server
13848 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13849
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013850parse-resolv-conf
13851 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13852 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13853 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13854
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013855hold <status> <period>
13856 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13857 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013858 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013859 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013860 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13861 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13862 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13863
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013864 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013865
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013866resolve_retries <nb>
13867 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13868 giving up.
13869 Default value: 3
13870
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013871 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13872 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13873 type.
13874
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013875timeout <event> <time>
13876 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13877 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13878 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013879 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13880 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013881 Default value: 1s
13882 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013883 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013884 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013885 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13886 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13887
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013888 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013889
13890 resolvers mydns
13891 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13892 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013893 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013894 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013895 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013896 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013897 hold other 30s
13898 hold refused 30s
13899 hold nx 30s
13900 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013901 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013902 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013903
13904
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200139056. Cache
13906---------
13907
13908HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13909(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13910RAM.
13911
13912The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13913this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13914
13915If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13916independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13917when we try to allocate a new one.
13918
13919The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13920
13921It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13922"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13923for more details.
13924
13925When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13926replaced by "<CACHE>".
13927
13928
139296.1. Limitation
13930----------------
13931
13932The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13933
13934- If the response is not a 200
13935- If the response contains a Vary header
13936- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13937- If the response is not cacheable
13938
13939- If the request is not a GET
13940- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13941- If the request contains an Authorization header
13942
13943
139446.2. Setup
13945-----------
13946
13947To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13948the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13949
13950
139516.2.1. Cache section
13952---------------------
13953
13954cache <name>
13955 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
13956 size of cache is mandatory.
13957
13958total-max-size <megabytes>
13959 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
13960 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
13961
13962max-object-size <bytes>
13963 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
13964 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
13965 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
13966
13967max-age <seconds>
13968 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
13969 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
13970 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
13971 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
13972 default.
13973
13974
139756.2.2. Proxy section
13976---------------------
13977
13978http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13979 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
13980 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
13981 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
13982 after this one.
13983
13984http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13985 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
13986 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
13987 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
13988 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
13989
13990
13991Example:
13992
13993 backend bck1
13994 mode http
13995
13996 http-request cache-use foobar
13997 http-response cache-store foobar
13998 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
13999
14000 cache foobar
14001 total-max-size 4
14002 max-age 240
14003
14004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140057. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14006----------------------------------
14007
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014008HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014009client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14010The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14011these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14012but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14013data called patterns.
14014
14015
140167.1. ACL basics
14017---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014018
14019The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14020content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14021from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14022simple :
14023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014024 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014025 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014026 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14027 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014029The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14030adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014031
14032In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014034 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014035
14036This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14037Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14038and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014039an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14040conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14041as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14042are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014043
14044ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14045'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14046which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14047
14048There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14049performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014051The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14052specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14053this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014054methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14055ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014056
14057Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14058 - boolean
14059 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14060 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14061 - string
14062 - data block
14063
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014064Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14065converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14066would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14067The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14068which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14069
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014070Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14071keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14072fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14073which are summarized in the table below :
14074
14075 +---------------------+-----------------+
14076 | Sample or converter | Default |
14077 | output type | matching method |
14078 +---------------------+-----------------+
14079 | boolean | bool |
14080 +---------------------+-----------------+
14081 | integer | int |
14082 +---------------------+-----------------+
14083 | ip | ip |
14084 +---------------------+-----------------+
14085 | string | str |
14086 +---------------------+-----------------+
14087 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14088 +---------------------+-----------------+
14089
14090Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14091matching method, see below.
14092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014093The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14094 - boolean
14095 - integer or integer range
14096 - IP address / network
14097 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14098 - regular expression
14099 - hex block
14100
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014101The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14102
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014103 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14104 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014105 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014106 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014107 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014108 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014109 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014111The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14112read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14113if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14114lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14115will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14116beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14117a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14118lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14119exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14120
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014121The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14122parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14123ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14124a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14125check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14126
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014127The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14128socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14129file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014131Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14132loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14133
14134 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14135
14136In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14137the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14138case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14139as well.
14140
14141The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14142sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14143do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14144methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14145is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014146obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014147followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14148default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14149that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14150string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14151
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014152The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14153By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14154string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14155resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14156server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014157waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014158flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14159function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014161There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14162sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14163be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014164
14165 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14166 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014167 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14168 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14169 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14170 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014171
14172 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14173 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014174 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014175
14176 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014177 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014178
14179 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014180 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014181
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014182 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014183 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14184
14185 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14186 binary or string samples.
14187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014188 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14189 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014191 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14192 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14193 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014195 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14196 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014198 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14199 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014200
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014201 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14202 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014204 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14205 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014206 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014208 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14209 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14210 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014211
14212For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14213request, it is possible to do :
14214
14215 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14216
14217In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14218buffer, one would use the following acl :
14219
14220 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14221
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014222On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14223possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14224
14225 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014227All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14228criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14229method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14230to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14231criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14232the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014234If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014235the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14236For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014238 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14239 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14240 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14241 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014242
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014243
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014244The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14245types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14246combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14247brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14248default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014250 +-------------------------------------------------+
14251 | Input sample type |
14252 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014253 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014254 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14255 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14256 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014257 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014258 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014259 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014260 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014261 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014262 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014263 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014264 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014265 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014266 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014267 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014268 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014269 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014270 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014271 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014273 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014274 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014275 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014276 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014277 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014278 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14279 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14280 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014281
14282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200142837.1.1. Matching booleans
14284------------------------
14285
14286In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14287Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14288When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14289that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14290
14291Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14292return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14293"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14294
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200142967.1.2. Matching integers
14297------------------------
14298
14299Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14300enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14301to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14302
14303Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14304matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14305lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014306
14307For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14308unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14309representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14310
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014311As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14312two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14313instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14314ranges and operators.
14315
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014316For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014317operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14318Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14319of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014320
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014321Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014322
14323 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14324 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14325 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14326 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14327 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14328
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014329For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014330
14331 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14332
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014333This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14334
14335 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143387.1.3. Matching strings
14339-----------------------
14340
14341String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14342different forms :
14343
14344 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014345 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014346
14347 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014348 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014349
14350 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14351 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14352
14353 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14354 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14355
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014356 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014357 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14358 matches.
14359
14360 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14361 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14362 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014363
14364String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14365exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14366characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14367string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14368to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014369before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014370
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014371Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14372(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14373Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14374
14375Example:
14376 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14377 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14378
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14381---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014382
14383Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14384they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14385possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14386passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14387the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014388the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14389match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014390
14391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143927.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14393-------------------------------------
14394
14395It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14396not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14397a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14398to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14399digits may be used upper or lower case.
14400
14401Example :
14402 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14403 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14404
14405
144067.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14407---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014408
14409IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14410netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14411within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014412host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014413difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14414at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14415does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14416parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014417
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014418The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14419abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14420
14421 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14422 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14423 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14424 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14425 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14426 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14427 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14428 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14429
14430Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14431192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14432
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014433IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14434Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14435trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14436IPv6 patterns.
14437
14438HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14439following situations :
14440 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14441 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14442 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14443 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14444 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14445 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14446 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14447 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14448 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14449 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014451
144527.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14453----------------------------------
14454
14455Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14456combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14457
14458 - AND (implicit)
14459 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14460 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014462A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014464 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014466Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14467indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014469For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14470"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14471requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14472is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14473
14474 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014475 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14476 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14477 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014478
14479To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14480and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14481
14482 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14483 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14484 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14485 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14486
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014487 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14489 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14490 use_backend www if host_www
14491
14492It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14493expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14494be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14495the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14496
14497 The following rule :
14498
14499 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014500 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014501
14502 Can also be written that way :
14503
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014504 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014505
14506It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14507to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14508simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14509sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14510good use is the following :
14511
14512 With named ACLs :
14513
14514 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14515 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14516 monitor fail if site_dead
14517
14518 With anonymous ACLs :
14519
14520 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14521
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014522See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14523keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524
14525
145267.3. Fetching samples
14527---------------------
14528
14529Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14530against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14531sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14532ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14533of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14534available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14535
14536This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14537Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14538compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14539deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14540
14541The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14542matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14543method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14544indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14545
14546As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14547when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14548mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14549the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14550ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14551
14552Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14553multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14554when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014555incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14556are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014557is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14558all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14559
14560Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14561 - name
14562 - name(arg1)
14563 - name(arg1,arg2)
14564
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014565
145667.3.1. Converters
14567-----------------
14568
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014569Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14570of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14571is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14572was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014573has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014574unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14575
14576These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14577sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14578the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014579support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014580
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014581A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14582support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14583supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14584(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14585bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014587The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014588
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001458951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14590 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14591 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14592 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14593 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14594 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14595
14596 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014597 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14598 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014599 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14600 frontend http-in
14601 bind *:8081
14602 default_backend servers
14603 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14604 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14605
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014606add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014607 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014608 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014609 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14610 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014611 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014612 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14613 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14614 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14615 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014616 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014617 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014618
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014619aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14620 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14621 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14622 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14623 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14624 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14625 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14626
14627 Example:
14628 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14629 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14630
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014631and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014632 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014633 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014634 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14635 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014636 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014637 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14638 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14639 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14640 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014641 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014642 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014643
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014644b64dec
14645 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14646 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14647
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014648base64
14649 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014650 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014651 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14652
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014653bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014654 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014655 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014656 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014657 presence of a flag).
14658
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014659bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14660 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14661 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014662 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014663
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014664concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14665 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14666 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14667 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14668 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14669 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14670 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14671 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14672 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14673 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14674 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014675 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14676 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14677 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14678 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014679
14680 Example:
14681 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14682 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14683 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014684 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014685 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14686
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014687cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014688 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14689 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014690
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014691crc32([<avalanche>])
14692 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14693 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14694 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14695 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14696 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14697 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14698 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14699 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14700 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14701 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014702 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14703
14704crc32c([<avalanche>])
14705 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14706 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14707 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14708 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14709 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14710 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14711 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14712 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014713
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014714cut_crlf
14715 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14716 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14717 updated.
14718
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014719da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014720 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14721 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14722 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14723 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014724 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014725 configuration language.
14726
14727 Example:
14728 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014729 bind *:8881
14730 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014731 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014732
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014733debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14734 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14735 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14736 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14737 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14738 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14739 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14740 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14741 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14742 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14743 printable sample types.
14744
14745 Example:
14746 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014747
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014748digest(<algorithm>)
14749 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
14750 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
14751
14752 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14753 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14754
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014755div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014756 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14757 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014758 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014759 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14760 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014761 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014762 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14763 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14764 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14765 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014766 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014767 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014768
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014769djb2([<avalanche>])
14770 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14771 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14772 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14773 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14774 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14775 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14776 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014777 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14778 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014779
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014780even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014781 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014782 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14783
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014784field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14785 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14786 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14787 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14788 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14789 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14790 fields.
14791
14792 Example :
14793 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14794 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14795 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14796 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14797 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014798
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014799hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014800 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014801 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014802 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014803 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014804
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014805hex2i
14806 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014807 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014808
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014809htonl
14810 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14811 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14812 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14813 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14814
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014815hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
14816 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
14817 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
14818 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
14819 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
14820
14821 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14822 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14823
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014824http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014825 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14826 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014827 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14828 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14829 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14830 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14831 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14832 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14833 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14834 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014835
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014836in_table(<table>)
14837 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14838 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14839 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014840 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014841 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14842
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014843ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14844 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014845 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014846 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14847 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14848 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14849 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14850 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014851
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014852json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014853 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014854 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014855 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014856 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14857 of errors:
14858 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14859 bytes, ...)
14860 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14861 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14862
14863 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14864 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14865 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14866 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14867 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14868 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014869 - "ascii" : never fails;
14870 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14871 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014872 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014873 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014874 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14875 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14876
14877 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014878 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014879
14880 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014881 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014882 capture request header user-agent len 150
14883 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014884
14885 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14886 GET / HTTP/1.0
14887 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14888
14889 Output log:
14890 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14891
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014892language(<value>[,<default>])
14893 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14894 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14895 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14896 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14897 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14898 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14899 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14900 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14901 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014902 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014903 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14904 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014905
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014906 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014907
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014908 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14909 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014910
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014911 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14912 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14913 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14914 use_backend spanish if es
14915 use_backend french if fr
14916 use_backend english if en
14917 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014918
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014919length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014920 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14921 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14922 type. The result is of type integer.
14923
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014924lower
14925 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14926 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14927 type. The result is of type string.
14928
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014929ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14930 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14931 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14932 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14933 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14934 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14935 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14936
14937 Example :
14938
14939 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014940 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014941 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14942
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014943ltrim(<chars>)
14944 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14945 representation of the input sample.
14946
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014947map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14948map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14949map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14950 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14951 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
14952 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
14953 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
14954 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
14955 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
14956 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
14957 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014958
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014959 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
14960 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
14961 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014962
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014963 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014964 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014965
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014966 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
14967 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14968 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
14969 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020014970 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
14971 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014972 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
14973 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14974 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
14975 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14976 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
14977 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14978 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
14979 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080014980 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
14981 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14982 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014983 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14984 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
14985 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
14986 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
14987 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014988
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010014989 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
14990 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
14991 the corresponding match text.
14992
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014993 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
14994 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
14995 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
14996 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
14997 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014998
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014999 Example :
15000
15001 # this is a comment and is ignored
15002 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15003 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15004 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15005 | | | `---------- value
15006 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15007 | `---------------------------- key
15008 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15009
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015010mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015011 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15012 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015013 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015014 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015015 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015016 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15017 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15018 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15019 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015020 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015021 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015022
15023mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015024 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015025 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15026 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015027 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015028 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015029 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015030 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15031 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15032 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15033 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015034 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015035 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015036
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015037nbsrv
15038 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15039 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15040 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15041 map lookup.
15042
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015043neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015044 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15045 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15046 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15047 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015048
15049not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015050 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015051 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015052 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015053 absence of a flag).
15054
15055odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015056 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015057 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15058
15059or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015060 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015061 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015062 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15063 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015064 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015065 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15066 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15067 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15068 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015069 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015070 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015071
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015072protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15073 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15074 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15075 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15076 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15077 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15078 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15079 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15080 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15081 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15082 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15083 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15084
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015085regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015086 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15087 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15088 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15089 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15090 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15091 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15092 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15093 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15094 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015095 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15096 of characters with other ones.
15097
15098 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15099 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15100 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15101 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15102 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15103 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015104
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015105 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015106
15107 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15108 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15109 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015110 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015111
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015112 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15113 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15114
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015115 # capture groups and backreferences
15116 # both lines do the same.
15117 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15118 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15119
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015120capture-req(<id>)
15121 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15122 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15123
15124 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015125 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15126 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015127
15128capture-res(<id>)
15129 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15130 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15131
15132 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015133 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15134 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015135
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015136rtrim(<chars>)
15137 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15138 of the input sample.
15139
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015140sdbm([<avalanche>])
15141 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15142 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15143 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15144 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15145 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15146 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15147 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015148 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15149 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015150
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015151secure_memcmp(<var>)
15152 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15153 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15154 match.
15155
15156 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15157 performed in constant time.
15158
15159 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15160 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15161
15162 Example :
15163
15164 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15165 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15166 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15167 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15168
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015169set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015170 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15171 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15172 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015173 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015174 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15175 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015176 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015177 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15178 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015179 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015180 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015181
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015182sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015183 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015184 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15185
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015186sha2([<bits>])
15187 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15188 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15189
15190 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15191 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15192
15193 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15194 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15195
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015196srv_queue
15197 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15198 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15199 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15200 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15201 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15202
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015203strcmp(<var>)
15204 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15205 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15206 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15207 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15208 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15209 shorter).
15210
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015211 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15212 strings in constant time.
15213
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015214 Example :
15215
15216 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15217 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15218 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15219
15220
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015221sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015222 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15223 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015224 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015225 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15226 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015227 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015228 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15229 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015230 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015231 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15232 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015233 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015234 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015235
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015236table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15237 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15238 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15239 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15240 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15241 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15242 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15243
15244
15245table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15246 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15247 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15248 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15249 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15250 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15251 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15252
15253table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15254 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15255 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015256 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015257 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15258 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15259
15260table_conn_cur(<table>)
15261 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15262 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15263 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15264 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15265 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15266
15267table_conn_rate(<table>)
15268 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15269 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15270 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15271 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15272 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15273
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015274table_gpt0(<table>)
15275 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15276 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15277 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15278 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15279 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15280
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015281table_gpc0(<table>)
15282 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15283 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15284 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15285 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15286 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15287
15288table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15289 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15290 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15291 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15292 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15293 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15294 sample fetch keyword.
15295
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015296table_gpc1(<table>)
15297 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15298 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15299 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15300 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15301 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15302
15303table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15304 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15305 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15306 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15307 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15308 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15309 sample fetch keyword.
15310
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015311table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15312 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15313 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015314 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015315 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15316 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15317
15318table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15319 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15320 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15321 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15322 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15323 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15324 keyword.
15325
15326table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15327 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15328 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015329 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015330 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15331 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15332
15333table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15334 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15335 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15336 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15337 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15338 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15339 keyword.
15340
15341table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15342 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15343 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015344 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015345 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15346 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15347 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15348 keyword.
15349
15350table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15351 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15352 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015353 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015354 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15355 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15356 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15357 keyword.
15358
15359table_server_id(<table>)
15360 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15361 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15362 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15363 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15364 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15365 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15366
15367table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15368 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15369 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015370 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015371 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15372 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15373 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15374 keyword.
15375
15376table_sess_rate(<table>)
15377 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15378 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15379 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15380 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15381 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15382 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15383 keyword.
15384
15385table_trackers(<table>)
15386 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15387 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15388 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15389 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15390 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15391 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15392 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15393 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15394 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15395 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15396
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015397upper
15398 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15399 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15400 type. The result is of type string.
15401
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015402url_dec([<in_form>])
15403 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15404 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15405 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15406 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15407 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15408 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015409
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015410ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015411 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015412 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15413 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15414 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015415 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15416 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15417 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15418 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015419 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015420 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15421 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015422
15423 Example:
15424 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15425 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15426
15427 message Point {
15428 int32 latitude = 1;
15429 int32 longitude = 2;
15430 }
15431
15432 message PPoint {
15433 Point point = 59;
15434 }
15435
15436 message Rectangle {
15437 // One corner of the rectangle.
15438 PPoint lo = 48;
15439 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15440 PPoint hi = 49;
15441 }
15442
15443 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15444 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15445 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
15446
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015447 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15448 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015449 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015450 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15451
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015452 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015453
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015454 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015455
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015456 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015457 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15458 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
15459
15460 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15461 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15462 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15463
15464 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15465 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15466 interpret the previous binary sample.
15467
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015468
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015469unset-var(<var name>)
15470 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15471 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15472 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15473 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15474 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15475 response),
15476 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15477 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15478 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15479 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15480
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015481utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15482 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15483 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15484 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15485 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15486 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15487 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15488
15489 Example :
15490
15491 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015492 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015493 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15494
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015495word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15496 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15497 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15498 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015499 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015500 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15501 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15502
15503 Example :
15504 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15505 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15506 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15507 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15508 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015509 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015510
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015511wt6([<avalanche>])
15512 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15513 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15514 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15515 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15516 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15517 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15518 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015519 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15520 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015521
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015522xor(<value>)
15523 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015524 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015525 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015526 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015527 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015528 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15529 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015530 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015531 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15532 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015533 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015534 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015535
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015536xxh32([<seed>])
15537 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15538 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15539 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15540 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15541 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15542 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15543 as cryptographically secure.
15544
15545xxh64([<seed>])
15546 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15547 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15548 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15549 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15550 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15551 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15552 as cryptographically secure.
15553
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015554
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200155557.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015556--------------------------------------------
15557
15558A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15559not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15560"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15561The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15562
15563always_false : boolean
15564 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15565 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15566
15567always_true : boolean
15568 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15569 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15570
15571avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015572 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015573 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15574 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15575 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15576 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15577 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15578 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15579 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15580 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15581 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15582 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15583 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15584 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15585 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015587be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015588 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15589 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15590 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15591 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015592 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15593
15594be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15595 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15596 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15597 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15598 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15599 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015600 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15601 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015602
15603 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15604 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15605 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015607be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15608 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15609 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15610 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015611 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15613 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015614
15615 Example :
15616 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15617 backend dynamic
15618 mode http
15619 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15620 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015621
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015622bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015623 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15624 of the string.
15625
15626bool(<bool>) : bool
15627 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15628 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15631 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015632 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15634 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015635
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015636 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015637 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015638 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15639
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015640 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15641 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015642
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015643 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015644 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015645 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015646 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015647 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015649 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015650
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015651 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15652 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015653 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015654 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015655
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015656cpu_calls : integer
15657 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15658 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15659 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15660 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15661 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15662 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15663
15664cpu_ns_avg : integer
15665 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15666 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15667 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15668 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15669 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15670 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15671 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15672 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15673 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15674 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15675 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15676
15677cpu_ns_tot : integer
15678 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15679 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15680 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15681 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15682 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15683 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15684 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15685 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15686 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15687 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15688 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15689 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15690 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15691
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015692date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015693 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015694
15695 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15696 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15697 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015698 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15699
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015700 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15701 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15702 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15703 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15704 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15705
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015706 Example :
15707
15708 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15709 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015710
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015711 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15712 # millisecond granularity
15713 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15714
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015715date_us : integer
15716 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15717 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15718 from the same timeval structure.
15719
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015720distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15721 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15722 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15723 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15724 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15725 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15726 list of supported tokens.
15727
15728distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15729 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15730 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15731 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15732 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15733 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15734 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15735 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15736 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15737 supported tokens.
15738
15739 Example :
15740 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15741 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15742 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15743 # send large files to the big farm
15744 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15745
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015746env(<name>) : string
15747 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15748 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15749 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15750 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15751 certain way.
15752
15753 Examples :
15754 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15755 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15756
15757 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15758 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015760fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15761 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015762 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15763 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015764 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15765 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015766 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015767 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15768 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015769
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015770fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15771 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15772 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15773 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015775fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15776 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15777 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15778 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15779 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15780 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15781 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15782 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15783 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015784
15785 Example :
15786 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15787 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15788 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15789 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15790 frontend mail
15791 bind :25
15792 mode tcp
15793 maxconn 100
15794 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15795 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15796 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15797 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015798
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015799hostname : string
15800 Returns the system hostname.
15801
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015802int(<integer>) : signed integer
15803 Returns a signed integer.
15804
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015805ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15806 Returns an ipv4.
15807
15808ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15809 Returns an ipv6.
15810
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015811lat_ns_avg : integer
15812 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15813 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15814 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15815 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15816 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15817 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15818 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15819 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15820 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15821 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15822 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15823 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15824 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
15825 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15826
15827lat_ns_tot : integer
15828 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15829 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15830 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15831 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15832 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15833 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15834 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15835 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15836 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
15837 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
15838 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
15839 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
15840 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
15841 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15842 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15843 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15844 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15845 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15846 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15847
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015848meth(<method>) : method
15849 Returns a method.
15850
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015851nbproc : integer
15852 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15853 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15854 and debugging purposes.
15855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015856nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15857 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15858 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15859 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015860 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15861 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15862 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015863
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015864prio_class : integer
15865 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15866 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15867 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15868
15869prio_offset : integer
15870 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15871 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15872 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15873 set-priority-offset".
15874
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015875proc : integer
15876 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15877 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15878 debugging purposes.
15879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015880queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015881 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15882 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15883 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015884 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15885 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15886 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15887 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15888 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15889
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015890rand([<range>]) : integer
15891 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15892 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15893 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15894 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15895 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15896
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015897uuid([<version>]) : string
15898 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15899 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15900 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015902srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15903 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15904 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15905 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15906 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15907 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015908 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15909 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15910
15911srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15912 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15913 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15914 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15915 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15916 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15917 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15918 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15919
15920 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15921 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922
15923srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15924 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15925 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15926 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015927 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015928 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15929 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15930 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15931
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015932srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15933 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15934 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15935 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15936 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15937 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15938 fetch methods.
15939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15941 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15942 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015943 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15945 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015946 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015947 overloading servers).
15948
15949 Example :
15950 # Redirect to a separate back
15951 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
15952 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
15953 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
15954
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015955stopping : boolean
15956 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
15957 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
15958 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
15959
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015960str(<string>) : string
15961 Returns a string.
15962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015963table_avl([<table>]) : integer
15964 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
15965 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
15966
15967table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15968 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
15969 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
15970 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
15971
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010015972thread : integer
15973 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
15974 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
15975 and debugging purposes.
15976
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015977var(<var-name>) : undefined
15978 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015979 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
15980 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015981 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015982 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15983 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015984 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015985 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15986 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015987 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015988 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015989
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200159907.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015991----------------------------------
15992
15993The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
15994closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
15995methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
15996sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
15997TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015998the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
15999counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016000"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16001used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16002can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16003Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16004table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16005tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16006currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016007
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016008bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016009 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16010 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16011 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016013be_id : integer
16014 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016015 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16016 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016017
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016018be_name : string
16019 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016020 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16021 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023dst : ip
16024 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16025 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16026 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16027 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016028 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16029 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16030 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16031 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16032 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16033 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034
16035dst_conn : integer
16036 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16037 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16038 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16039 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16040 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16041 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16042 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16043 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016044
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016045dst_is_local : boolean
16046 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16047 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16048 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16049 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016050 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016051 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16052 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16053 it only once per connection.
16054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016055dst_port : integer
16056 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16057 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16058 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16059 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16060 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16061 an HTTP header.
16062
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016063fc_http_major : integer
16064 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16065 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16066 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16067
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016068fc_pp_authority : string
16069 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16070 if any.
16071
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016072fc_pp_unique_id : string
16073 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16074 if any.
16075
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016076fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16077 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16078 header.
16079
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016080fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16081 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16082 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16083 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16084 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16085 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16086 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16087
16088fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16089 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16090 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16091 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16092 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16093 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16094 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16095
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016096fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016097 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16098 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16099 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16100 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16101
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016102fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016103 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16104 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16105 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16106 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16107
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016108fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016109 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16110 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16111 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16112 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16113
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016114fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016115 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16116 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16117 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16118 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16119
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016120fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016121 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16122 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16123 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16124 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16125
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016126fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016127 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16128 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16129 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16130 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16131
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016132fe_defbe : string
16133 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16134 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136fe_id : integer
16137 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016138 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16140
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016141fe_name : string
16142 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16143 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16144 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16145
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016146sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016147sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16148sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16149sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016150 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16151 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16152 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16153
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016154sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016155sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16156sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16157sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016158 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16159 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16160 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16161
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016162sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016163sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16164sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16165sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016166 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16167 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016168 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16169 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16170 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016171
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016172 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016173 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16174 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016175 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16176 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16177 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016178 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16179 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16180
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016181sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16182sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16183sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16184sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16185 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16186 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16187 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16188 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16189 when a first ACL was verified.
16190
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016191sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016192sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16193sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16194sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016195 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016196 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16197
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016198sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016199sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16200sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16201sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016202 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16203 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16204 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16205
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016206sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016207sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16208sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16209sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016210 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16211 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16212 See also src_conn_rate.
16213
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016214sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016215sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16216sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16217sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016218 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016219 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016220
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016221sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16222sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16223sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16224sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16225 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16226 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16227
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016228sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16229sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16230sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16231sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16232 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16233 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16234
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016235sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016236sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16237sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16238sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016239 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16240 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16241 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016242 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16243 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16244 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016245
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016246sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16247sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16248sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16249sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16250 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16251 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16252 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16253 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16254 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16255 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16256
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016257sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016258sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16259sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16260sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016261 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016262 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16263 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16264
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016265sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016266sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16267sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16268sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016269 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16270 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16271 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16272 src_http_err_rate.
16273
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016274sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016275sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16276sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16277sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016278 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016279 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16280 src_http_req_cnt.
16281
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016282sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016283sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16284sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16285sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016286 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16287 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16288 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16289 src_http_req_rate.
16290
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016291sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016292sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16293sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16294sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016295 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016296 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16297 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16298 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16299 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016300
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016301 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016302 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16303 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016304 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16305
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016306sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16307sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16308sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16309sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16310 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16311 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16312 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16313 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16314 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16315
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016316sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016317sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16318sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16319sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016320 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16321 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16322 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016323
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016324sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016325sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16326sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16327sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016328 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16329 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16330 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016331
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016332sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016333sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16334sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16335sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016336 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016337 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16338 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16339 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016340 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016341 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16342
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016343sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016344sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16345sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16346sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016347 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16348 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16349 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16350 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16351 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016352 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016353
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016354sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016355sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16356sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16357sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016358 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16359 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16360 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16361
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016362sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016363sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16364sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16365sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016366 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16367 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016368 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016369 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16370 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016371 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16372 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16373 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016375so_id : integer
16376 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16377 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16378 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016379
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016380so_name : string
16381 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16382 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16383 strings instead of integers.
16384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016385src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016386 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016387 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16388 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16389 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016390 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16391 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16392 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016393 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16394 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16395 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16396 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16397 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16398 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16399 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016400
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016401 Example:
16402 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16403 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016405src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16406 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16407 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16408 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016409 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016411src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16412 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16413 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016414 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016415 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016417src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16418 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16419 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16420 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16421 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16422 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16423 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016424
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016425 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016426 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16427 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16428 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16429 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016430 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016431 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16432 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16433
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016434src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16435 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16436 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16437 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16438 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16439 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16440 was verified.
16441
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016442src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016443 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016444 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016445 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016446 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016448src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016449 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016450 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16451 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016452 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016454src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16455 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16456 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16457 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016458 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016460src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016461 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016462 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016463 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016464 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016465
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016466src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16467 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16468 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16469 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16470 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16471
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016472src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16473 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16474 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16475 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16476 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016478src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016479 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016480 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016481 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16482 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016483 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16484 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16485 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016486
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016487src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16488 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16489 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16490 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16491 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16492 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16493 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16494 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016496src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016497 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016498 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016499 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016500 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016501 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016503src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16504 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16505 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16506 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16507 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016508 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016510src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016511 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016512 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16513 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016514 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016516src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16517 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16518 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16519 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016520 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016521 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016523src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16524 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16525 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16526 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016527 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016528 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16529 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016530
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016531 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016532 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016533 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016534 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016535
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016536src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16537 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16538 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16539 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16540 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16541 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16542 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16543
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016544src_is_local : boolean
16545 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16546 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16547 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16548 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016549 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016550 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16551 once per connection.
16552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016553src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016554 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16555 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16556 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16557 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16558 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016560src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016561 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16562 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16563 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16564 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16565 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016567src_port : integer
16568 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16569 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16570 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16571 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016573src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016574 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016575 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16576 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16577 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016578 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016580src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16581 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16582 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16583 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16584 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016585 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016587src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16588 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16589 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16590 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16591 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16592 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16593 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16594 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16595 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016596
16597 Example :
16598 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16599 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16600 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16601 listen ssh
16602 bind :22
16603 mode tcp
16604 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016605 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016606 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016607 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016609srv_id : integer
16610 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16611 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016612 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016613
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016614srv_name : string
16615 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16616 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016617 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016618
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166197.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016620----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016622The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16623closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16624when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16625usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016626future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016627
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001662851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16629 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16630 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16631 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16632 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16633 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16634
16635 Example :
16636 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16637 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16638 # the request.
16639 frontend http-in
16640 bind *:8081
16641 default_backend servers
16642 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16643 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16644
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016645ssl_bc : boolean
16646 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16647 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016648 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16649 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016650
16651ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16652 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016653 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16654 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016655
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016656ssl_bc_alpn : string
16657 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16658 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016659 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016660 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16661 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16662 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16663 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16664 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016665 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16666 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016667
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016668ssl_bc_cipher : string
16669 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016670 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16671 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016672
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016673ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16674 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16675 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16676 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016677 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016678
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016679ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16680 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16681 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016682 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16683 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016684
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016685ssl_bc_npn : string
16686 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16687 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016688 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016689 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16690 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16691 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16692 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016693 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16694 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016695
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016696ssl_bc_protocol : string
16697 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016698 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16699 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016700
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016701ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016702 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016703 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016704 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16705 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016706
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016707ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16708 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16709 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16710 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016711 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016712
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016713ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16714 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16715 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016716 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16717 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016718
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016719ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16720 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16721 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16722 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016723 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016724
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016725ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16726 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016727 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16728 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016730ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16731 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16732 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16733 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16734 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16735 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016736
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016737ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16738 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16739 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16740 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16741 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016742
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016743ssl_c_der : binary
16744 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16745 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16746 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016748ssl_c_err : integer
16749 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16750 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16751 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16752 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16753 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016754
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016755ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016756 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16757 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16758 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16759 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16760 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16761 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16762 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16763 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016764 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16765 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16766 LDAP v3.
16767 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16768 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016769
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016770ssl_c_key_alg : string
16771 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16772 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16773 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016775ssl_c_notafter : string
16776 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16777 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16778 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016780ssl_c_notbefore : string
16781 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16782 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16783 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016784
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016785ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016786 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16787 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16788 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16789 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16790 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16791 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16792 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16793 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016794 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16795 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16796 LDAP v3.
16797 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16798 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016800ssl_c_serial : binary
16801 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16802 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16803 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016805ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16806 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16807 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16808 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016809 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16810 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16811
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016812 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016813 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016815ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16816 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16817 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16818 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016820ssl_c_used : boolean
16821 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16822 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016824ssl_c_verify : integer
16825 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16826 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16827 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16828 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016830ssl_c_version : integer
16831 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16832 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016833
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016834ssl_f_der : binary
16835 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16836 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16837 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16838
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016839ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016840 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16841 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16842 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16843 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016844 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016845 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16846 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16847 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016848 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16849 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16850 LDAP v3.
16851 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16852 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016854ssl_f_key_alg : string
16855 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16856 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16857 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016859ssl_f_notafter : string
16860 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16861 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16862 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016864ssl_f_notbefore : string
16865 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16866 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16867 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016868
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016869ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016870 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16871 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16872 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16873 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16874 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16875 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16876 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16877 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016878 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16879 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16880 LDAP v3.
16881 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16882 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016884ssl_f_serial : binary
16885 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16886 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16887 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016888
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016889ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16890 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16891 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16892 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016894ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16895 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16896 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16897 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016899ssl_f_version : integer
16900 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16901 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16902
16903ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016904 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16905 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16906 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016908 Example :
16909 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16910 listen http-https
16911 bind :80
16912 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16913 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16914
16915ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16916 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16917 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16918
16919ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016920 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016921 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16922 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16923 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16924 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16925 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16926 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16927 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16928 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016930ssl_fc_cipher : string
16931 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16932 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016933
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016934ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16935 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16936 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016937 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016938
16939ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16940 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16941 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016942 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016943
16944ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16945 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16946 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16947 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016948 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016949 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016950
16951ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
16952 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
16953 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016954 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016955
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016956ssl_fc_client_random : binary
16957 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
16958 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16959 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
16960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016961ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016962 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
16963 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010016964 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
16965 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
16966 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
16967 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016968
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020016969ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
16970 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
16971 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
16972 wait until the handshake happened.
16973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016974ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
16975 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016976 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
16977 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016978 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020016979 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016980
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020016981ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016982 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010016983 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
16984 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020016985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016986ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016987 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016988 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
16989 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
16990 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
16991 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
16992 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
16993 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
16994 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020016995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016996ssl_fc_protocol : string
16997 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
16998 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020016999
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017000ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017001 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017002 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17003 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017004
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017005ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17006 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17007 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17008 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017010ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17011 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17012 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17013 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17014 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017015
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017016ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17017 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17018 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17019 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17020 BoringSSL.
17021
17022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017023ssl_fc_sni : string
17024 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17025 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17026 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17027 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17028 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17029
17030 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17031 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17032 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017033 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017034 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017036 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017037 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17038 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017040ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17041 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17042 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017043
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017044
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170457.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017046------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017048Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17049sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17050only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17051For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17052be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17053can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17054sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17055for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17056content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017058payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017059 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017060 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17061 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017063payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17064 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017065 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017066 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017067
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017068req.hdrs : string
17069 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17070 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17071 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17072 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17073
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017074req.hdrs_bin : binary
17075 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17076 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17077 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17078 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17079 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17080 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17081
17082 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17083
17084 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17085 str: <int:length><bytes>
17086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017087req.len : integer
17088req_len : integer (deprecated)
17089 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17090 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17091 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17092 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17093 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17094 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17095 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17096 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017098req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17099 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017100 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17101 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17102 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17103 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017105 ACL alternatives :
17106 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017108req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17109 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17110 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17111 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17112 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017114 ACL alternatives :
17115 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017116
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017117 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017119req.proto_http : boolean
17120req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17121 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17122 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17123 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17124 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17125 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17126 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17127 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017129 Example:
17130 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17131 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17132 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017133 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017135req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17136rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17137 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17138 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17139 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17140 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17141 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17142 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17143 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017145 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17146 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17147 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17148 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17149 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17150 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017152 ACL derivatives :
17153 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017155 Example :
17156 listen tse-farm
17157 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17158 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17159 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17160 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17161 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17162 persist rdp-cookie
17163 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17164 # This is only useful makes sense if
17165 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17166 stick-table type string size 204800
17167 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17168 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17169 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017171 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17172 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017174req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17175rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17176 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17177 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17178 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17179 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017181 ACL derivatives :
17182 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017183
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017184req.ssl_alpn : string
17185 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17186 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17187 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17188 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17189 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17190 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017191 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017192
17193 Examples :
17194 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17195 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17196 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017197 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017198 default_backend bk_default
17199
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017200req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17201 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17202 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017203 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17204 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17205 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17206 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17207 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017209req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17210req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17211 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17212 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17213 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17214 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17215 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17216 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17217 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017219req.ssl_sni : string
17220req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17221 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17222 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17223 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17224 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17225 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17226 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
17227 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
17228 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
17229 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
17230 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
17231 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
17232 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017234 ACL derivatives :
17235 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017237 Examples :
17238 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17239 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17240 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17241 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17242 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017243
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017244req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17245 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17246 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17247 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17248 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17249 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17250 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17251 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17252 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17253 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017255req.ssl_ver : integer
17256req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17257 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17258 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17259 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17260 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17261 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17262 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17263 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017264 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017265 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017267 ACL derivatives :
17268 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017269
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017270res.len : integer
17271 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17272 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17273 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17274 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17275 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17276 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17277 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017278 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017280res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17281 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017282 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017283 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017284 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017285 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017287res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17288 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17289 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17290 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017291 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17292 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017294 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017295
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017296res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17297rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17298 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17299 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17300 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17301 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17302 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17303 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17304 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17305
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017306wait_end : boolean
17307 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17308 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017309 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017310 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17311 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017312 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017313 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17314 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017316 Examples :
17317 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17318 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17319 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017321 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17322 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17323 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17324 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17325 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17326 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17327 tcp-request content reject
17328
17329
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200173307.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017331--------------------------------------
17332
17333It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17334This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17335data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17336its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17337HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17338content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17339to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17340more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17341response are indexed.
17342
17343base : string
17344 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17345 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17346 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17347 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17348 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17349 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17350 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17351 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17352
17353 ACL derivatives :
17354 base : exact string match
17355 base_beg : prefix match
17356 base_dir : subdir match
17357 base_dom : domain match
17358 base_end : suffix match
17359 base_len : length match
17360 base_reg : regex match
17361 base_sub : substring match
17362
17363base32 : integer
17364 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17365 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17366 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017367 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17368 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17369 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017370
17371base32+src : binary
17372 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17373 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17374 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17375 per-URL counters.
17376
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017377capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17378 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17379 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17380 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17381
17382capture.req.method : string
17383 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17384 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17385 because it's allocated.
17386
17387capture.req.uri : string
17388 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17389 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17390 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17391 allocated.
17392
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017393capture.req.ver : string
17394 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17395 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17396 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17397
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017398capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17399 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17400 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17401 The first entry is an index of 0.
17402 See also: "capture response header"
17403
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017404capture.res.ver : string
17405 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17406 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17407 persistent flag.
17408
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017409req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017410 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17411 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17412 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017413
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017414req.body_param([<name>) : string
17415 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17416 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17417 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17418 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17419 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17420 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17421 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17422 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17423 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17424 given.
17425
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017426req.body_len : integer
17427 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17428 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017429 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17430 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017431
17432req.body_size : integer
17433 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017434 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17435 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017437req.cook([<name>]) : string
17438cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17439 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17440 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17441 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17442 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17443 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17444 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17445 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17446 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17447
17448 ACL derivatives :
17449 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17450 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17451 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17452 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17453 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17454 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17455 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17456 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017458req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17459cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17460 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17461 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017463req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17464cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17465 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17466 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17467 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17468 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017470cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17471 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17472 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17473 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17474 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017475 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017476 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17477 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17478 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17479 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017481hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17482 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17483 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17484 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17485 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017486 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017488req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17489 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17490 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17491 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17492 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17493 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17494 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17495 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17496 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017498req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17499 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17500 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17501 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17502 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017504req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17505 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17506 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17507 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17508 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17509 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17510 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17511 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17512 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017513 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017514 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017515 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017517 ACL derivatives :
17518 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17519 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17520 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17521 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17522 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17523 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17524 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17525 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17526
17527req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17528hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17529 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17530 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17531 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17532 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17533 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17534 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17535 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17536 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17537 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17538
17539req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17540hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17541 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17542 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17543 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17544 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17545 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017546 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017547 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17548 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17549
17550req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17551hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17552 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17553 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17554 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17555 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17556 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17557 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17558 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17559
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017560
17561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017562http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17563 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17564 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17565 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17566 basic auth is supported.
17567
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017568http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17569 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17570 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17571 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17572 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017573 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17574 basic auth is supported.
17575
17576 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017577 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17578 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17579 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17580 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017581
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017582http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017583 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17584 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17585 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017586
17587http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017588 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17589 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17590 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017591
17592http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017593 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17594 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17595 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017597http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017598 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17599 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017600 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17601 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017603method : integer + string
17604 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17605 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17606 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17607 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17608 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17609 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17610 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017612 ACL derivatives :
17613 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017615 Example :
17616 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17617 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17618 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017620path : string
17621 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17622 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17623 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17624 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17625 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017626 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017627 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017629 ACL derivatives :
17630 path : exact string match
17631 path_beg : prefix match
17632 path_dir : subdir match
17633 path_dom : domain match
17634 path_end : suffix match
17635 path_len : length match
17636 path_reg : regex match
17637 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017638
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017639query : string
17640 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17641 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17642 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17643 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017644 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017645 which stops before the question mark.
17646
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017647req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17648 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17649 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17650 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17651 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017653req.ver : string
17654req_ver : string (deprecated)
17655 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17656 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17657 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017659 ACL derivatives :
17660 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017661
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017662res.body : binary
17663 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
17664 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17665 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17666 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17667
17668res.body_len : integer
17669 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
17670 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17671 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17672 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17673
17674res.body_size : integer
17675 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
17676 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17677 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
17678 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
17679 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
17680 based expect rules.
17681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017682res.comp : boolean
17683 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17684 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17685 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017687res.comp_algo : string
17688 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17689 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17690 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017692res.cook([<name>]) : string
17693scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17694 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17695 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017696 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
17697 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017699 ACL derivatives :
17700 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017702res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17703scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17704 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17705 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017706 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
17707 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017709res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17710scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17711 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17712 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017713 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
17714 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017716res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17717 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17718 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17719 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17720 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17721 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17722 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17723 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17724 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017725 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017727res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17728 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17729 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17730 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17731 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017732 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
17733 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017735res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17736shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17737 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17738 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17739 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17740 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17741 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17742 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17743 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017744 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
17745 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017747 ACL derivatives :
17748 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17749 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17750 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17751 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17752 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17753 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17754 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17755 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17756
17757res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17758shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17759 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17760 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17761 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17762 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017763 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017765res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17766shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17767 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17768 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17769 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17770 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17771 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017772 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
17773 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017774
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017775res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17776 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17777 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17778 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017779 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
17780 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017782res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17783shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17784 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17785 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17786 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17787 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17788 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017789 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
17790 based expect rules.
17791
17792res.hdrs : string
17793 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
17794 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17795 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17796 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
17797 based expect rules.
17798
17799res.hdrs_bin : binary
17800 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17801 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
17802 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
17803 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
17804 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
17805 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
17806 (length of 0 for both).
17807
17808 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17809
17810 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17811 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017813res.ver : string
17814resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17815 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017816 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
17817 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017819 ACL derivatives :
17820 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017822set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17823 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17824 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017825 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017826 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017828 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17829 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017831status : integer
17832 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17833 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017834 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
17835 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017836
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017837unique-id : string
17838 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17839 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17840 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17841 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17842 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17843 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017845url : string
17846 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17847 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17848 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17849 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17850 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17851 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17852 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017854 ACL derivatives :
17855 url : exact string match
17856 url_beg : prefix match
17857 url_dir : subdir match
17858 url_dom : domain match
17859 url_end : suffix match
17860 url_len : length match
17861 url_reg : regex match
17862 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017864url_ip : ip
17865 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17866 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17867 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17868 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17869 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17870 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17871 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017873url_port : integer
17874 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17875 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17876 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17877 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017878
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017879urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17880url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017881 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
17882 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017883 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
17884 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
17885 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
17886 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017887 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
17888 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017889 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
17890 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017892 ACL derivatives :
17893 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
17894 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
17895 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
17896 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
17897 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
17898 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
17899 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
17900 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017901
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017903 Example :
17904 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
17905 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
17906 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
17907 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017908
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017909urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017910 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
17911 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
17912 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020017913
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020017914url32 : integer
17915 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
17916 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
17917 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
17918 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
17919 is an unsigned integer.
17920
17921url32+src : binary
17922 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
17923 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
17924 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
17925
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020017926
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200179277.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017928---------------------------------------
17929
17930This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
17931used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
17932purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
17933There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
17934or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
17935any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
17936for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
17937
17938internal.htx.data : integer
17939 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
17940 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17941
17942internal.htx.free : integer
17943 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
17944 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17945
17946internal.htx.free_data : integer
17947 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
17948 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17949
17950internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
17951 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
17952 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
17953 chosen depending on the sample direction.
17954
17955internal.htx.nbblks : integer
17956 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
17957 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17958
17959internal.htx.size : integer
17960 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
17961 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17962
17963internal.htx.used : integer
17964 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
17965 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
17966 direction.
17967
17968internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
17969 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17970 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
17971 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
17972 of the special value :
17973 * head : The oldest inserted block
17974 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017975 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017976
17977internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
17978 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17979 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
17980 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
17981 integer or one of the special value :
17982 * head : The oldest inserted block
17983 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017984 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017985
17986internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
17987 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
17988 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
17989 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
17990 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
17991
17992 * head : The oldest inserted block
17993 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050017994 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010017995
17996internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
17997 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
17998 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
17999 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18000 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18001
18002 * head : The oldest inserted block
18003 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018004 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018005
18006internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18007 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18008 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18009 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18010 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18011
18012 * head : The oldest inserted block
18013 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018014 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018015
18016internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18017 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18018 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18019 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18020 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18021
18022 * head : The oldest inserted block
18023 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018024 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018025
18026internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18027 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18028 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18029 it returns false.
18030
18031
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200180327.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018033---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018035Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18036every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018037order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018038
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018039ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18040---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018041FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018042HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018043HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18044HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018045HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18046HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18047HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18048HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18049LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018050METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018051METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018052METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18053METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18054METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18055METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018056METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018057METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018058RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018059REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018060TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018061WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18062---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018063
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180658. Logging
18066----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018067
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018068One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18069provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18070very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18071provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18072state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018073to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018074headers.
18075
18076In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18077about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18078send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18079
18080 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18081 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18082 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18083 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18084 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018085 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018086 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018087
18088The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18089allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18090as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18091while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18092real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18093delay.
18094
18095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180968.1. Log levels
18097---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018098
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018099TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018100source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018101HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18102in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18103track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18104syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18105about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018106
18107
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181088.2. Log formats
18109----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018110
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018111HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018112and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18113slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18114options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018115
18116 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18117 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18118 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18119 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18120 extents.
18121
18122 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18123 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18124 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18125 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18126 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18127
18128 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18129 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18130 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18131 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18132 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18133
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018134 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18135 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18136 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18137 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18138
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018139 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18140
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018141Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18142specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18143field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18144servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18145always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18146identifier.
18147
18148Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18149 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18150 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18151 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18152 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18153
18154
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181558.2.1. Default log format
18156-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018157
18158This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18159as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18160format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18161
18162 Example :
18163 listen www
18164 mode http
18165 log global
18166 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18167
18168 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18169 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18170 (www/HTTP)
18171
18172 Field Format Extract from the example above
18173 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18174 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18175 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18176 4 'to' to
18177 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18178 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18179
18180Detailed fields description :
18181 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18182 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18183 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18184 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18185 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18186 and processed the connection.
18187 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18188
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018189In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18190"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18191connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18192
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018193It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18194will eventually disappear.
18195
18196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181978.2.2. TCP log format
18198---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018199
18200The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18201is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18202information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18203counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18204emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18205environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18206the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18207sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018208specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18209not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18210fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18211marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018212
18213 Example :
18214 frontend fnt
18215 mode tcp
18216 option tcplog
18217 log global
18218 default_backend bck
18219
18220 backend bck
18221 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18222
18223 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18224 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18225 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18226
18227 Field Format Extract from the example above
18228 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18229 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18230 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18231 4 frontend_name fnt
18232 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18233 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18234 7 bytes_read* 212
18235 8 termination_state --
18236 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18237 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18238
18239Detailed fields description :
18240 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018241 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18242 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18243 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018244 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018245 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018246 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018247
18248 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018249 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18250 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18251 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018252
18253 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18254 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18255 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018256 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18257 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18258 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18259 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018260
18261 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18262 and processed the connection.
18263
18264 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18265 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18266 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18267 applications.
18268
18269 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18270 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18271 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18272 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18273 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18274
18275 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18276 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18277 See "Timers" below for more details.
18278
18279 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18280 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18281 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18282 "Timers" below for more details.
18283
18284 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018285 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018286 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18287 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18288 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18289 details.
18290
18291 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18292 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18293 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18294 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18295 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18296
18297 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18298 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18299 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18300 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18301 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18302 for more details.
18303
18304 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018305 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018306 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18307 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18308 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018309 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018310
18311 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18312 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18313 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18314 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18315 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18316 caused by a denial of service attack.
18317
18318 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18319 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18320 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18321 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18322 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18323 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18324 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18325 denial of service attack.
18326
18327 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18328 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18329 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18330 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18331 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18332 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18333 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18334 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18335 be processed than on other servers.
18336
18337 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18338 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18339 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18340 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18341 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18342 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18343 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18344 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18345 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18346 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18347 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18348 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18349 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18350
18351 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18352 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18353 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18354 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18355 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18356 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018357 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018358 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18359
18360 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18361 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18362 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18363 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18364 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18365 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018366 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018367 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18368 occurs.
18369
18370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183718.2.3. HTTP log format
18372----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018373
18374The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18375is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18376the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18377are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18378emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18379generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18380"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18381which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018382frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18383is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018384
18385Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18386slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18387with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18388
18389 Example :
18390 frontend http-in
18391 mode http
18392 option httplog
18393 log global
18394 default_backend bck
18395
18396 backend static
18397 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18398
18399 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18400 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18401 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018402 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018403
18404 Field Format Extract from the example above
18405 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18406 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018407 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018408 4 frontend_name http-in
18409 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018410 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018411 7 status_code 200
18412 8 bytes_read* 2750
18413 9 captured_request_cookie -
18414 10 captured_response_cookie -
18415 11 termination_state ----
18416 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18417 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18418 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18419 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18420 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018421
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018422Detailed fields description :
18423 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018424 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18425 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18426 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018427 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018428 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018429 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018430
18431 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018432 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18433 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18434 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018435
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018436 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18437 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018438
18439 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18440 and processed the connection.
18441
18442 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18443 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18444 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18445
18446 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18447 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18448 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18449 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18450 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18451 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18452
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018453 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18454 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18455 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018456 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018457 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18458 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018459 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18460 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018461
18462 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18463 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018464 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018465
18466 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18467 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018468 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18469 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018470
18471 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18472 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18473 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18474 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18475 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018476 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18477 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018478
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018479 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18480 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18481 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18482 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18483 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18484 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18485 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018486 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018487
18488 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18489 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18490 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18491
18492 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18493 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018494 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018495 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18496 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18497 overflowing.
18498
18499 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18500 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18501 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18502 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18503 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18504 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18505 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18506 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18507
18508 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18509 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18510 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18511 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18512 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18513 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18514 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18515 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18516
18517 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18518 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18519 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18520 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18521 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18522 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18523 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18524
18525 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018526 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018527 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18528 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18529 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018530 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018531 system.
18532
18533 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18534 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18535 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18536 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18537 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18538 caused by a denial of service attack.
18539
18540 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18541 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18542 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18543 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18544 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18545 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18546 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18547 denial of service attack.
18548
18549 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18550 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18551 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18552 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18553 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18554 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18555 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18556 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18557 processed than on other servers.
18558
18559 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18560 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18561 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18562 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18563 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18564 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18565 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18566 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18567 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18568 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18569 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18570 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18571 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18572
18573 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18574 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18575 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18576 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18577 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18578 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018579 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018580 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18581
18582 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18583 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18584 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18585 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18586 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18587 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018588 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018589 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18590 occurs.
18591
18592 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18593 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18594 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18595 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18596 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18597 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18598 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18599 cookies" below for more details.
18600
18601 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18602 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18603 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18604 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18605 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18606 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18607 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18608 and cookies" below for more details.
18609
18610 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18611 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18612 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18613 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18614 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18615 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18616 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18617 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18618
18619
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200186208.2.4. Custom log format
18621------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018622
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018623The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018624mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018625
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018626HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018627Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18628separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18629prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18630
18631Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18632variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018633("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018634
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018635If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018636as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018637less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18638the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18639
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018640Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018641In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018642in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018643
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018644Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18645'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18646https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18647such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18648
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018649Flags are :
18650 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018651 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018652 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18653 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018654
18655 Example:
18656
18657 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18658 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18659
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018660 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18661
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018662At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18663
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018664 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18665 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018666
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018667the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018668
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018669 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18670 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18671 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018672
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018673and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18674
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018675 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18676 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018677
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018678Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18679
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018680 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018681 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018682 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18683 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18684 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018685 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18686 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18687 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018688 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018689 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18690 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018691 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018692 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18693 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018694 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018695 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018696 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018697 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018698 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018699 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018700 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018701 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18702 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18703 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18704 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18705 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018706 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018707 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018708 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018709 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018710 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018711 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18712 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018713 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18714 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18715 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018716 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018717 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18718 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018719 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018720 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18721 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18722 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018723 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018724 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018725 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18726 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18727 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18728 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018729 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018730 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018731 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018732 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018733 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018734 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018735 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18736 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18737 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018738 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018739 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18740 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018741 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018742 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18743 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018744 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018745 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018746 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018747 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018748
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018749 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018750
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018751
187528.2.5. Error log format
18753-----------------------
18754
18755When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18756protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18757By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18758"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018759will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018760logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18761
18762The format looks like this :
18763
18764 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18765 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18766 Connection error during SSL handshake
18767
18768 Field Format Extract from the example above
18769 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18770 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18771 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18772 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18773 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18774
18775These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18776failures.
18777
18778
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187798.3. Advanced logging options
18780-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018781
18782Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18783just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18784options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18785for more information about their usage.
18786
18787
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187888.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18789------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018790
18791It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18792haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18793commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18794monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18795ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18796
18797 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18798 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18799 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18800 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18801
18802 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18803 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18804 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018805 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018806 such as other load-balancers.
18807
18808 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18809 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18810 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18811
18812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188138.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18814----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018815
18816The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18817what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18818or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018819"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018820just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18821log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18822after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18823is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18824with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18825with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18826
18827
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188288.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18829------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018830
18831Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18832for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18833"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18834retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18835raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18836a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18837file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18838you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18839"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18840
18841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188428.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18843--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018844
18845Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18846multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18847them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18848"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18849logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18850error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18851and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18852too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18853useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18854alternative.
18855
18856
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188578.4. Timing events
18858------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018859
18860Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18861reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18862the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18863frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018864mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18865addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18866
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018867Timings events in HTTP mode:
18868
18869 first request 2nd request
18870 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18871 t tr t tr ...
18872 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18873 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18874 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18875 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018876 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018877 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18878
18879Timings events in TCP mode:
18880
18881 TCP session
18882 |<----------------->|
18883 t t
18884 ---|----|----|----|----|---
18885 | Th Tw Tc Td |
18886 |<------ Tt ------->|
18887
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018888 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018889 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018890 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
18891 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
18892 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018893 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018894 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
18895 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
18896 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
18897 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018898
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018899 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
18900 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
18901 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018902 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
18903 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
18904 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
18905 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
18906 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
18907 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018908
18909 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
18910 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
18911 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
18912 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
18913 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
18914 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
18915 request typed by hand during a test.
18916
18917 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
18918 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018919 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018920 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
18921 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
18922 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
18923 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018924
18925 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
18926 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
18927 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
18928 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
18929 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
18930
18931 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
18932 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
18933 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
18934 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
18935 connection never established.
18936
18937 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
18938 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
18939 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
18940 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
18941 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
18942 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
18943 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
18944 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
18945 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
18946 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
18947 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
18948
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018949 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
18950 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
18951 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
18952 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
18953 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
18954 by subtracting other timers when valid :
18955
18956 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
18957
18958 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
18959 "Ta" can never be negative.
18960
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018961 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
18962 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018963 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
18964 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018965 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018966
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018967 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018968
18969 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018970 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
18971 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018972
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018973 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
18974 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
18975 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
18976 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
18977 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
18978 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
18979 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
18980 prefixed with a '+' sign.
18981
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018982These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
18983protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
18984that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018985due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
18986"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
18987that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018988
18989Most common cases :
18990
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018991 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
18992 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
18993 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
18994 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
18995 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
18996 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
18997 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
18998 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
18999 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19000 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19001 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019002 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019003
19004 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19005 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19006 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19007 of ms on remote networks.
19008
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019009 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19010 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19011 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019012
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019013 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19014 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19015 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19016 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19017 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19018 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19019 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19020 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19021 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019022
19023Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19024
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019025 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019026 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019027 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019028
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019029 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019030 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19031 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19032
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019033 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019034 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19035 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19036 flags.
19037
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019038 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19039 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019040 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19041 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19042 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19043 the client connection was maintained open.
19044
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019045 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019046 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019047 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019048 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19049
19050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190518.5. Session state at disconnection
19052-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019053
19054TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19055"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
190562-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19057each of which has a special meaning :
19058
19059 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19060 session to terminate :
19061
19062 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19063
19064 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19065 server explicitly refused it.
19066
19067 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19068 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19069 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19070 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019071 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019072
19073 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19074 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019075
19076 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19077 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19078 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19079 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19080 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19081
19082 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19083 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19084 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19085 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19086 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19087
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019088 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19089 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19090
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019091 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19092 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19093 backup connections when going up.
19094
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019095 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19096
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019097 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19098 send or receive data.
19099
19100 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19101 send or receive data.
19102
19103 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19104 with nothing left in the buffers.
19105
19106 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19107
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019108 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019109 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19110
19111 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19112 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19113 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19114 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19115 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19116
19117 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19118 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19119
19120 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19121 server (HTTP only).
19122
19123 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19124
19125 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19126 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19127 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19128
19129 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19130 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19131 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19132
19133 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19134
19135 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19136 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19137
19138 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19139 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19140 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19141
19142 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19143 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019144 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19145 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019146
19147 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19148 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19149 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19150 another server.
19151
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019152 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019153 server.
19154
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019155 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19156 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19157 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19158 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19159
19160 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19161 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19162 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19163 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19164
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019165 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19166 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19167 "use-server" rule).
19168
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019169 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19170
19171 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19172 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19173
19174 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19175
19176 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19177 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19178 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19179
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019180 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19181 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019182 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019183 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19184 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19185
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019186 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19187
19188 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19189 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19190
19191 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19192
19193 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19194
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019195The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19196was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019197helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19198starvation, attacks, etc...
19199
19200The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19201alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19202easier finding and understanding.
19203
19204 Flags Reason
19205
19206 -- Normal termination.
19207
19208 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19209 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19210 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19211 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19212
19213 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19214 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19215 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19216 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19217 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19218 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019219
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019220 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19221 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019222 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019223
19224 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19225 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19226 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19227
19228 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19229 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19230 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19231 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19232 the server takes too long to respond.
19233
19234 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19235 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19236 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19237 long a time to respond.
19238
19239 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19240 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19241 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19242 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019243 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19244 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019245
19246 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19247 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19248 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19249 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19250 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019251 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019252 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19253 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19254 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19255 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19256 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19257 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19258 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19259 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019260 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019261 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19262 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19263 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019264
19265 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19266 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019267 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19268 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19269 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19270 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019271
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019272 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19273 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19274
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019275 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019276 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19277 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019278 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019279 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19280 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19281
19282 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19283 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19284 503 or 504 here.
19285
19286 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19287 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19288 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19289 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19290 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19291
19292 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19293 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019294 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019295 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19296 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19297
19298 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19299 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19300 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19301 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19302 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19303 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19304 between haproxy and the server.
19305
19306 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19307 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19308 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19309 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19310 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19311 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19312 solution is to fix the application.
19313
19314 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19315 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19316 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19317 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19318 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19319 external attacks.
19320
19321 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19322 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019323 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019324 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19325 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19326
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019327 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19328 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19329 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019330 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019331 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019332
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019333 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19334 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19335 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19336 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019337 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19338 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19339 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19340 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19341 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019342
19343 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19344 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19345 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19346 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19347
19348 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19349 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19350 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19351 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19352
19353 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19354 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19355 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19356 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19357
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019358The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19359persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19360important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19361re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19362
19363 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19364
19365 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19366 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19367 set on a GET request.
19368
19369 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19370 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019371 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019372 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19373
19374 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19375 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19376 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19377
19378 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19379 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19380 already got a cookie.
19381
19382 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19383 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19384 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19385 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19386 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19387
19388 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19389 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19390 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19391
19392 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19393 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19394 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19395
19396 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19397 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19398
19399 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19400 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19401 then advertised in the response.
19402
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019403
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194048.6. Non-printable characters
19405-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019406
19407In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19408consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19409converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19410prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19411being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19412escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19413is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19414'}' when logging headers.
19415
19416Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19417issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19418containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19419
19420Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19421the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19422performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19423
19424
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194258.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19426---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019427
19428Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19429achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019430section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019431cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19432the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19433the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019434locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019435not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19436user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19437a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19438wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19439
19440 Examples :
19441 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19442 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19443
19444 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19445 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19446
19447
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200194488.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19449---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019450
19451Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19452proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19453the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19454server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19455
19456Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19457response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019458section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019459
19460It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019461time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19462appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019463are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19464and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19465follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19466request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19467in the logs.
19468
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019469As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19470frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19471an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19472
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019473 Example :
19474 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19475 listen proxy-out
19476 mode http
19477 option httplog
19478 option logasap
19479 log global
19480 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19481
19482 # log the name of the virtual server
19483 capture request header Host len 20
19484
19485 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19486 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19487
19488 # log the beginning of the referrer
19489 capture request header Referer len 20
19490
19491 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19492 capture response header Server len 20
19493
19494 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19495 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19496
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019497 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019498 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19499
19500 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19501 capture response header Via len 20
19502
19503 # log the URL location during a redirection
19504 capture response header Location len 20
19505
19506 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19507 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19508 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19509 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19510 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19511
19512 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19513 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19514 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19515 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019516 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019517
19518 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19519 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19520 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19521 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19522 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019523 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019524
19525
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195268.9. Examples of logs
19527---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019528
19529These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19530them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19531reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19532
19533 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19534 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19535 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19536
19537 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19538 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19539
19540 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19541 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19542 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19543
19544 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19545 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19546
19547 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19548 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19549 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19550
19551 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019552 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019553 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19554 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19555
19556 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19557 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19558 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19559
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019560 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19561 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19562 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19563 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19564 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19565 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019566
19567 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019568 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019569
19570 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19571 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19572 Nothing was sent to any server.
19573
19574 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19575 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19576
19577 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19578 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019579 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019580 send a 408 return code to the client.
19581
19582 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19583 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19584
19585 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19586 5 seconds ("c----").
19587
19588 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19589 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019590 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019591
19592 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019593 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019594 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19595 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19596 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19597 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19598 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019599
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019600
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200196019. Supported filters
19602--------------------
19603
19604Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19605accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19606unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19607
19608See also : "filter"
19609
196109.1. Trace
19611----------
19612
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019613filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019614
19615 Arguments:
19616 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19617 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19618
19619 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19620 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19621 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19622 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19623
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019624 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019625 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19626 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19627 amount of the parsed data.
19628
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019629 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019630
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019631This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19632callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19633information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19634filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19635
19636Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19637tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19638a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19639
19640
196419.2. HTTP compression
19642---------------------
19643
19644filter compression
19645
19646The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19647keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019648when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19649fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19650done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19651explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19652filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19653listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19654order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019655
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019656See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19657 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019658
19659
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200196609.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19661--------------------------------------------
19662
19663filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19664
19665 Arguments :
19666
19667 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19668 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19669 parsed.
19670
19671 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19672 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19673 part must be placed in its own scope.
19674
19675The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19676external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019677streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019678exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19679also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19680
19681SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19682the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19683
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019684For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019685"doc/SPOE.txt".
19686
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100196879.4. Cache
19688----------
19689
19690filter cache <name>
19691
19692 Arguments :
19693
19694 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19695
19696The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19697"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019698cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019699other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19700case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19701is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19702filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019703listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19704order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019705
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019706See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19707 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19708
19709
197109.5. Fcgi-app
19711-------------
19712
19713filter fcg-app <name>
19714
19715 Arguments :
19716
19717 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19718
19719The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19720request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19721reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19722used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19723implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19724used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19725fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19726used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19727order.
19728
19729See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19730 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19731
19732
1973310. FastCGI applications
19734-------------------------
19735
19736HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19737feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19738the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19739FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19740servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19741FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19742backend.
19743
19744HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19745application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19746connection.
19747
1974810.1. Setup
19749-----------
19750
1975110.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19752--------------------------
19753
19754fcgi-app <name>
19755 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19756 document root must be defined.
19757
19758acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19759 Declare or complete an access list.
19760
19761 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19762 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19763 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19764 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19765 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19766
19767docroot <path>
19768 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19769 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19770 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19771
19772index <script-name>
19773 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19774 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19775 is an optional setting.
19776
19777 Example :
19778 index index.php
19779
19780log-stderr global
19781log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19782 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19783 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19784
19785 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19786 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19787
19788pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19789 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19790 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19791 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19792
19793 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19794 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19795 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19796 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19797
19798 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19799 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19800
19801path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019802 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019803 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19804 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19805 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19806 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19807 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19808 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19809 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019810
19811 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019812 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019813 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19814 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19815 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19816 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019817
19818 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019819 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19820 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019821
19822option get-values
19823no option get-values
19824 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19825
19826 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19827 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19828
19829 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19830 application will accept.
19831
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019832 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19833 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019834
19835 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
19836 the connexion immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
19837 option is disabled.
19838
19839 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19840 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19841 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19842 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19843 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19844 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19845
19846option keep-conn
19847no option keep-conn
19848 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19849 sending a response.
19850
19851 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19852 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19853
19854option max-reqs <reqs>
19855 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19856 accept.
19857
19858 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19859 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19860 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19861 to 1.
19862
19863option mpxs-conns
19864no option mpxs-conns
19865 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19866
19867 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19868 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19869
19870set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19871 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19872 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19873 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19874 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19875
19876 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19877 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19878 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19879
19880 Example :
19881 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
19882 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
19883
19884 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
19885
19886
1988710.1.2. Proxy section
19888---------------------
19889
19890use-fcgi-app <name>
19891 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
19892
19893 Arguments :
19894 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
19895
19896 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
19897 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
19898 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
19899 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
19900 application may be defined at a time per backend.
19901
19902 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
19903 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
19904 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
19905 application are evaluated.
19906
19907
1990810.1.3. Example
19909---------------
19910
19911 frontend front-http
19912 mode http
19913 bind *:80
19914 bind *:
19915
19916 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
19917 default_backend back-static
19918
19919 backend back-static
19920 mode http
19921 server www A.B.C.D:80
19922
19923 backend back-dynamic
19924 mode http
19925 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
19926 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
19927
19928 fcgi-app php-fpm
19929 log-stderr global
19930 option keep-conn
19931
19932 docroot /var/www/my-app
19933 index index.php
19934 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
19935
19936
1993710.2. Default parameters
19938------------------------
19939
19940A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
19941the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019942script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019943applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
19944
19945 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19946 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
19947 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
19948 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
19949 | | |
19950 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19951 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
19952 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
19953 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
19954 | | application. |
19955 | | |
19956 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19957 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
19958 | | the request. It may not be set. |
19959 | | |
19960 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19961 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
19962 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
19963 | | the application's configuration. |
19964 | | |
19965 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19966 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
19967 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
19968 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
19969 | | |
19970 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19971 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
19972 | | following the part that identifies the script |
19973 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
19974 | | be defined. |
19975 | | |
19976 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19977 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
19978 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
19979 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
19980 | | is not set too. |
19981 | | |
19982 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19983 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
19984 | | set. |
19985 | | |
19986 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19987 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
19988 | | the request. |
19989 | | |
19990 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19991 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
19992 | | client as part of user authentication. |
19993 | | |
19994 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19995 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
19996 | | script to process the request. |
19997 | | |
19998 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
19999 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20000 | | |
20001 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20002 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20003 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20004 | | |
20005 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20006 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20007 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20008 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20009 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20010 | | |
20011 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20012 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20013 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20014 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20015 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20016 | | side. |
20017 | | |
20018 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20019 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20020 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20021 | | connected to. |
20022 | | |
20023 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20024 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20025 | | |
20026 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20027 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20028 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20029 | | |
20030 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20031
20032
2003310.3. Limitations
20034------------------
20035
20036The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20037way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20038during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20039establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20040application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20041or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20042message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20043these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20044and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20045
20046Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20047request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20048requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20049
20050About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20051into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20052fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20053"http-request" ones.
20054
20055Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20056FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20057processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20058must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20059here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020061/*
20062 * Local variables:
20063 * fill-column: 79
20064 * End:
20065 */